blob: 228e8132e80926d87b3aaff5923dd0f74b3a7b1b [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau0e658fb2016-11-25 16:55:50 +01005 version 1.8
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaue59fcdd2016-11-25 16:39:17 +01007 2016/11/25
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111
1121. Quick reminder about HTTP
113----------------------------
114
115When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
116fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
117on almost anything found in the contents.
118
119However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
120formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
121correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
122
123
1241.1. The HTTP transaction model
125-------------------------------
126
127The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100128to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
130connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
131will involve a new connection :
132
133 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
134
135In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
136establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
137by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
138length.
139
140Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
141to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
142however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
143response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
144header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
145
146 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
147
148Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
149power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
150but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200151a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152
153A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
154keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
155second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
156page :
157
158 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
159
160This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
161latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
162correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
163the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100164server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100166By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
167connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
168leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
169start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200170
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100171HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
172 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
173 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
174 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
175 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
176 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
177 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179
1801.2. HTTP request
181-----------------
182
183First, let's consider this HTTP request :
184
185 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100186 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
188 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
189 3 User-agent: my small browser
190 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
191 5 Accept: image/png
192
193
1941.2.1. The Request line
195-----------------------
196
197Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
198
199 - a METHOD : GET
200 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
201 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
202
203All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
204which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
205followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
206is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
207desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
208the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
209
210The URI itself can have several forms :
211
212 - A "relative URI" :
213
214 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
217 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
218
219 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
220
221 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
222
223 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
224 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
225 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
226 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
227 must accept this form too.
228
229 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
230 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
231 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100232
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200233 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
234 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
235 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
236 other protocols too.
237
238In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
239mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
240on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
241It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
242specific to the language, framework or application in use.
243
244
2451.2.2. The request headers
246--------------------------
247
248The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
249beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
250an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
251Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
252values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
253encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
254the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
255define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
256
257Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
258their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
259"Connection:" header).
260
261The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
262that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
263is one valid form of empty line.
264
265Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
266headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
267about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
268application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
269
270Important note:
271 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
272 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
273 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
274 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
275
276
2771.3. HTTP response
278------------------
279
280An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
281messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
282
283 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100284 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
286 2 Content-length: 350
287 3 Content-Type: text/html
288
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200289As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
290codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
291response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100292continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
293the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
294following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
295sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
296(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
297correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
298such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
299state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
300over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
301if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
302information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304
3051.3.1. The Response line
306------------------------
307
308Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
309
310 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
311 - a status code : 200
312 - a reason : OK
313
314The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200315 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
317 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
318 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
319 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
320
321Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
324messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
325or "Authentication Required".
326
327Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
328
329 Code When / reason
330 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
331 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
332 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
333 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100334 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
335 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200336 400 for an invalid or too large request
337 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
338 accessing the stats page)
339 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
340 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
341 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
342 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
343 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
344 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
345 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
346 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
347 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
348
349The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3504.2).
351
352
3531.3.2. The response headers
354---------------------------
355
356Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
357the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
358details.
359
360
3612. Configuring HAProxy
362----------------------
363
3642.1. Configuration file format
365------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200366
367HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
368
369 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
370 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
371 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
372 "frontend" and "backend".
373
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100374The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
375referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200376delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003792.2. Quoting and escaping
380-------------------------
381
382HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
383many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
384with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
385single quotes.
386
387If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
388them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
389escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
390
391Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
392
393 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
394 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
395 \\ to use a backslash
396 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
397 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
398
399Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
400the interpretation of:
401
402 space as a parameter separator
403 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
404 # hash as a comment start
405
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200406Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
407-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
408backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
409
410Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200411quoting.
412
413Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
414nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
415
416Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
417equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
418
419 Example:
420 # those are equivalents:
421 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
422 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
423 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
424 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
425 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
426
427 # those are equivalents:
428 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
431 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
432
433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004342.3. Environment variables
435--------------------------
436
437HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
438interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
439configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
440optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
441shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
442underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
443
444 Example:
445
446 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
447
448 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
449
450 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
451
452
4532.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200454----------------
455
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100456Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100457values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
458otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
459numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
460for every keyword. Supported units are :
461
462 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
463 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
464 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
465 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
466 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
467 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
468
469
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004702.4. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200471-------------
472
473 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
474 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
475 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
476 global
477 daemon
478 maxconn 256
479
480 defaults
481 mode http
482 timeout connect 5000ms
483 timeout client 50000ms
484 timeout server 50000ms
485
486 frontend http-in
487 bind *:80
488 default_backend servers
489
490 backend servers
491 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
492
493
494 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
495 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
496 global
497 daemon
498 maxconn 256
499
500 defaults
501 mode http
502 timeout connect 5000ms
503 timeout client 50000ms
504 timeout server 50000ms
505
506 listen http-in
507 bind *:80
508 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
509
510
511Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
512
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100513 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200514
515
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005163. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517--------------------
518
519Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
520are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
521of them have command-line equivalents.
522
523The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
524
525 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200526 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200527 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200528 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200529 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200530 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200531 - description
532 - deviceatlas-json-file
533 - deviceatlas-log-level
534 - deviceatlas-separator
535 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900536 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200537 - gid
538 - group
539 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200540 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100541 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200542 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200543 - nbproc
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200544 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200545 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100546 - presetenv
547 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200548 - uid
549 - ulimit-n
550 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100551 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200552 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200553 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
554 - ssl-default-bind-options
555 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
556 - ssl-default-server-options
557 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100558 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100559 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100560 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100561 - 51degrees-data-file
562 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200563 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200564 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100565 - wurfl-data-file
566 - wurfl-information-list
567 - wurfl-information-list-separator
568 - wurfl-engine-mode
569 - wurfl-cache-size
570 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100571
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200572 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200573 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200575 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100576 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100577 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100578 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200579 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200580 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200581 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200582 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200583 - noepoll
584 - nokqueue
585 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100586 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300587 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000588 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200589 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200590 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200591 - server-state-file
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200592 - tune.buffers.limit
593 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200594 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200595 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100596 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100597 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200598 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100599 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100600 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100601 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100602 - tune.lua.session-timeout
603 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200604 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100605 - tune.maxaccept
606 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200607 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200608 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200609 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100610 - tune.rcvbuf.client
611 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100612 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100613 - tune.sndbuf.client
614 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100615 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100616 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200617 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100618 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200619 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200620 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100621 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200622 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100623 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200624 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
625 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
626 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100627 - tune.zlib.memlevel
628 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100629
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200630 * Debugging
631 - debug
632 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200633
634
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006353.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200636------------------------------------
637
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200638ca-base <dir>
639 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200640 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
641 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200642
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200643chroot <jail dir>
644 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
645 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
646 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
647 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
648 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
649 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100650
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100651cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
652 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
653 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
654 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100655 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
656 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
657 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
658 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
659 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
660 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
661 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
662 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
663 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
664 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100665
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200666crt-base <dir>
667 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
668 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
669 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
670
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200671daemon
672 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
673 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
674 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
675
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200676deviceatlas-json-file <path>
677 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
678 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
679
680deviceatlas-log-level <value>
681 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
682 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
683
684deviceatlas-separator <char>
685 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
686 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
687
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100688deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200689 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
690 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
691 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100692
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900693external-check
694 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
695 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
696 See "option external-check".
697
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200698gid <number>
699 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
700 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
701 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100702 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
703 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200704 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100705
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200706group <group name>
707 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
708 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100709
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200710log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200711 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
712 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100713 configured with "log global".
714
715 <address> can be one of:
716
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100717 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100718 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
719 port).
720
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100721 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
722 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
723 port).
724
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100725 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
726 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
727 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
728 writeable).
729
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200730 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
731 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100732
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200733 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
734 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
735 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
736 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
737 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
738 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
739 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
740 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
741 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
742 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
743 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
744
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200745 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
746 one of the following :
747
748 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
749 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
750
751 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
752 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
753
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100754 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200755
756 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
757 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
758 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
759
760 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200761 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
762 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
763 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
764 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
765 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
766 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200767
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200768 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200769
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100770log-send-hostname [<string>]
771 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
772 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
773 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
774 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
775 the logs.
776
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000777log-tag <string>
778 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
779 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
780 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100781 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000782
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100783lua-load <file>
784 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
785 used multiple times.
786
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200787nbproc <number>
788 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
789 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
790 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
791 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
792 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
793
794pidfile <pidfile>
795 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
796 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
797 starting the process. See also "daemon".
798
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100799presetenv <name> <value>
800 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
801 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
802 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
803 and "unsetenv".
804
805resetenv [<name> ...]
806 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
807 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
808 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
809 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
810 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
811 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
812 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
813 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
814
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100815stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200816 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
817 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
818 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
819 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
820 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
821 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100822 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200823 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
824 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200825
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200826server-state-base <directory>
827 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200828 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
829 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200830
831server-state-file <file>
832 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
833 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
834 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
835 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
836 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
837 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
838 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
839 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200840 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
841 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200842
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100843setenv <name> <value>
844 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
845 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
846 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
847 and "unsetenv".
848
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100849ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
850 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
851 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300852 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100853 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
854 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
855 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
856 "bind" keyword for more information.
857
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100858ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
859 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
860 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
861 keyword to see available options.
862
863 Example:
864 global
865 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
866
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100867ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
868 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
869 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300870 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100871 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
872 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
873 information.
874
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100875ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
876 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
877 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
878 keyword to see available options.
879
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200880ssl-dh-param-file <file>
881 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
882 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
883 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
884 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
885 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200886 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
887 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
888 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
889 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200890 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
891 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
892 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
893
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100894ssl-server-verify [none|required]
895 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
896 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
897 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
898
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200899stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
900 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
901 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
902 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200903 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
904 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200905
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200906 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
907 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
908 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200909
910stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
911 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
912 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100913 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200914
915stats maxconn <connections>
916 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
917 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
918
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200919uid <number>
920 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
921 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
922 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
923 one. See also "gid" and "user".
924
925ulimit-n <number>
926 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
927 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
928 option.
929
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100930unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
931 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
932
933 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
934 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
935 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
936 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
937 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
938 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
939 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
940 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
941 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
942 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
943
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100944unsetenv [<name> ...]
945 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
946 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
947 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
948 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
949 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
950 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
951 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
952
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200953user <user name>
954 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
955 See also "uid" and "group".
956
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200957node <name>
958 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
959
960 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
961 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
962 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
963 traffic.
964
965description <text>
966 Add a text that describes the instance.
967
968 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
969 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
970 "<" and ">" characters.
971
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010097251degrees-data-file <file path>
973 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
974 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
975
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200976 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100977 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
978
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000097951degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100980 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
981 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
982 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
983
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200984 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100985 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
986
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +020098751degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100988 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
989 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
990
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200991 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
992 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
993
99451degrees-cache-size <number>
995 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
996 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
997 By default, this cache is disabled.
998
999 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001000 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1001
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001002wurfl-data-file <file path>
1003 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1004 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1005
1006 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1007 with USE_WURFL=1.
1008
1009wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1010 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1011 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1012 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1013
1014 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1015
1016 Valid WURFL properties are:
1017 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1018
1019 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1020 device.
1021
1022 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1023 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1024
1025 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1026 particular web request.
1027
1028 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1029 used Libwurfl API version.
1030
1031 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1032 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1033 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1034
1035 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1036 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1037
1038 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1039 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1040
1041 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1042
1043 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1044
1045 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1046 with USE_WURFL=1.
1047
1048wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1049 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1050 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1051
1052 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1053 with USE_WURFL=1.
1054
1055wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1056 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1057 thus before the chroot.
1058
1059 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1060 with USE_WURFL=1.
1061
1062wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1063 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1064 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
1065 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
1066 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
1067 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
1068 mode is enabled by default.
1069
1070 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1071 with USE_WURFL=1.
1072
1073wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1074 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1075 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1076 - "0" : no cache is used.
1077 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1078 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1079 the highest performing option.
1080
1081 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1082 with USE_WURFL=1.
1083
1084wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1085 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1086 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1087
1088 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1089 with USE_WURFL=1.
1090
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001091
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010923.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001093-----------------------
1094
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001095max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1096 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1097 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1098 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1099 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1100 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1101 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1102 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1103 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1104
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001105maxconn <number>
1106 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1107 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1108 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001109 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1110 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1111 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1112 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001113 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1114 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1115 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1116 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1117 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001118
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001119maxconnrate <number>
1120 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1121 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1122 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1123 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1124 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1125 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1126 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1127 fairness.
1128
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001129maxcomprate <number>
1130 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001131 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001132 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1133 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1134 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1135 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1136 default value.
1137
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001138maxcompcpuusage <number>
1139 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1140 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1141 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1142 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1143 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1144 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1145 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1146 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1147
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001148maxpipes <number>
1149 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1150 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1151 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1152 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1153 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1154 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1155
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001156maxsessrate <number>
1157 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1158 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1159 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1160 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1161 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1162 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1163 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1164 fairness.
1165
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001166maxsslconn <number>
1167 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1168 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1169 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1170 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1171 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1172 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1173 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001174 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1175 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1176 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1177 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1178 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1179 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1180 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001181
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001182maxsslrate <number>
1183 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1184 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1185 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1186 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1187 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1188 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1189 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1190 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1191 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1192 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1193
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001194maxzlibmem <number>
1195 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1196 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1197 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001198 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1199 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1200 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1201
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001202noepoll
1203 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1204 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001205 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001206
1207nokqueue
1208 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1209 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1210 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1211
1212nopoll
1213 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1214 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001215 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001216 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001217
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001218nosplice
1219 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1220 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1221 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001222 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001223 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1224 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1225 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1226 "option splice-response".
1227
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001228nogetaddrinfo
1229 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1230 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1231
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001232noreuseport
1233 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1234 command line argument "-dR".
1235
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001236spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001237 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1238 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1239 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1240 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1241 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1242 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001243
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001244tune.buffers.limit <number>
1245 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1246 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1247 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1248 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1249 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1250 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1251 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1252 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1253 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1254 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1255 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1256 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1257 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1258 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1259 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1260
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001261tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1262 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1263 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1264 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1265 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1266
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001267tune.bufsize <number>
1268 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1269 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1270 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1271 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1272 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1273 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1274 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1275 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001276 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1277 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1278 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001279
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001280tune.chksize <number>
1281 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1282 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1283 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1284 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1285 checks whenever possible.
1286
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001287tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1288 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1289 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1290 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1291 this value. The default value is 1.
1292
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001293tune.http.cookielen <number>
1294 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1295 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1296 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1297 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1298 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1299 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1300 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1301 to change this value.
1302
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001303tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1304 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1305 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1306 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1307 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1308 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1309 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1310 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1311 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1312 limit too high.
1313
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001314tune.idletimer <timeout>
1315 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1316 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1317 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1318 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1319 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1320 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1321 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1322 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1323 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1324
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001325tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1326 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001327 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001328 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1329 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1330 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1331 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1332 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1333
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001334tune.lua.maxmem
1335 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1336 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1337 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1338 memory.
1339
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001340tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1341 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001342 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1343 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1344 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001345
1346tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1347 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1348 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1349 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1350 check servers.
1351
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001352tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1353 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1354 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1355 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1356 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1357
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001358tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001359 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1360 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1361 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1362 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1363 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1364 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1365 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1366 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1367 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1368 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001369
1370tune.maxpollevents <number>
1371 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1372 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1373 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1374 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1375 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1376
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001377tune.maxrewrite <number>
1378 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1379 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1380 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1381 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1382 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1383 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1384 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1385 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1386 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1387 bufsize.
1388
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001389tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1390 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1391 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1392 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1393 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1394 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1395 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1396 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1397 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1398 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1399 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1400 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1401 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1402 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1403 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1404 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1405 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1406 setting this parameter to 0.
1407
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001408tune.pipesize <number>
1409 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1410 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1411 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1412 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1413 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1414 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1415
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001416tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1417tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1418 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1419 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1420 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1421 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1422 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1423 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1424 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1425
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001426tune.recv_enough <number>
1427 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1428 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1429 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1430 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1431 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1432
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001433tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1434tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1435 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1436 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1437 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1438 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1439 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1440 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1441 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1442 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1443 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1444 notifying haproxy again.
1445
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001446tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001447 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1448 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1449 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001450 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001451 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1452 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1453 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1454 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1455 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001456 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1457 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001458
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001459tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1460 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1461 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1462 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1463 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1464 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1465 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1466
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001467tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1468 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001469 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001470 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1471 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1472 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1473 being used for too long.
1474
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001475tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1476 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1477 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1478 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1479 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1480 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1481 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1482 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1483 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1484 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1485 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001486 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1487 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001488
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001489tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1490 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1491 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1492 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1493 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1494 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1495 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1496 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001497 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1498 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001499
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001500tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1501 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1502 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1503 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1504 1000 entries.
1505
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001506tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1507 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1508 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1509 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1510
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001511tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001512tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001513tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1514tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1515tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001516 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1517 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1518 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1519 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1520 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1521 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1522 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1523 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001524
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001525 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1526 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1527 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1528 all available space is consumed.
1529 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1530 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1531 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001532
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001533tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1534 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001535 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001536 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1537 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1538 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1539
1540tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1541 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1542 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1543 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1544 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015463.3. Debugging
1547--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001548
1549debug
1550 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1551 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1552 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1553 system startup.
1554
1555quiet
1556 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1557 line argument "-q".
1558
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001559
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015603.4. Userlists
1561--------------
1562It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1563http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1564it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1565
1566userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001567 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001568 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1569
1570group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001571 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001572 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1573 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1574
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001575user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1576 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001577 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1578 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001579 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1580 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001581 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001582 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001583
1584
1585 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001586 userlist L1
1587 group G1 users tiger,scott
1588 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001589
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001590 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1591 user scott insecure-password elgato
1592 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001593
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001594 userlist L2
1595 group G1
1596 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001597
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001598 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1599 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1600 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001601
1602 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001603
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001604
16053.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001606----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001607It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1608several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1609instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1610values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1611automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1612In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1613using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1614tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1615reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1616Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1617that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1618each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001619
1620peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001621 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001622 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1623
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001624disabled
1625 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1626 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1627 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1628
1629enable
1630 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1631
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001632peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1633 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1634 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1635 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1636 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1637 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1638 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1639
1640 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1641 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1642
1643 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1644 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1645 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1646 across all peers.
1647
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001648 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1649 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001650
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001651 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001652 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001653 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1654 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1655 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001656
1657 backend mybackend
1658 mode tcp
1659 balance roundrobin
1660 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1661 stick on src
1662
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001663 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1664 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001665
1666
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090016673.6. Mailers
1668------------
1669It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1670If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1671in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1672
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001673mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001674 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1675 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1676
1677mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1678 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1679
1680 Example:
1681 mailers mymailers
1682 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1683 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1684
1685 backend mybackend
1686 mode tcp
1687 balance roundrobin
1688
1689 email-alert mailers mymailers
1690 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1691 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1692
1693 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1694 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1695
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001696timeout mail <time>
1697 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1698 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1699 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1700 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1701
1702 Example:
1703 mailers mymailers
1704 timeout mail 20s
1705 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001706
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017074. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001708----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001709
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001710Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001711 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001712 - frontend <name>
1713 - backend <name>
1714 - listen <name>
1715
1716A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1717its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1718section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001719section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001720
1721A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1722connections.
1723
1724A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1725to forward incoming connections.
1726
1727A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1728parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1729
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001730All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1731'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1732case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1733
1734Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1735logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1736proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1737However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1738name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1739
1740Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1741and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001742bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001743protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1744modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1745arbitrary criteria.
1746
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001747In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1748a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1749the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1750
1751 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1752 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1753 between responses and new requests.
1754
1755 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1756 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1757 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1758 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1759
1760 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1761 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1762 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1763
1764 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1765 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1766 client-facing connection remains open.
1767
1768 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1769 after the end of the response.
1770
1771The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1772frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1773following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1774weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1775
1776 Backend mode
1777
1778 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1779 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1780 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1781 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1782 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1783 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1784 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1785 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1786 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1787 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1788 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1789
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001790
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001791
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017924.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1793--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001794
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001795The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1796limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1797they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1798limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001799marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001800option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001801and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1802with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1803specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001804
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001805
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001806 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1807------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1808acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001809appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001810backlog X X X -
1811balance X - X X
1812bind - X X -
1813bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02001814block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001815capture cookie - X X -
1816capture request header - X X -
1817capture response header - X X -
1818clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001819compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001820contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1821cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001822declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001823default-server X - X X
1824default_backend X X X -
1825description - X X X
1826disabled X X X X
1827dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001828email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001829email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001830email-alert mailers X X X X
1831email-alert myhostname X X X X
1832email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001833enabled X X X X
1834errorfile X X X X
1835errorloc X X X X
1836errorloc302 X X X X
1837-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1838errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001839force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001840filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001841fullconn X - X X
1842grace X X X X
1843hash-type X - X X
1844http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001845http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001846http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001847http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001848http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001849http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001850http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001851id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001852ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001853load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001854log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001855log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001856log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001857log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001858max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001859maxconn X X X -
1860mode X X X X
1861monitor fail - X X -
1862monitor-net X X X -
1863monitor-uri X X X -
1864option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1865option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1866option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1867option allbackups (*) X - X X
1868option checkcache (*) X - X X
1869option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1870option contstats (*) X X X -
1871option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1872option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1873option forceclose (*) X X X X
1874-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1875option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001876option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001877option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001878option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001879option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001880option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001881option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001882option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001883option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1884option httpchk X - X X
1885option httpclose (*) X X X X
1886option httplog X X X X
1887option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001888option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001889option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001890option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001891option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1892option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1893option logasap (*) X X X -
1894option mysql-check X - X X
1895option nolinger (*) X X X X
1896option originalto X X X X
1897option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02001898option pgsql-check X - X X
1899option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001900option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001901option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001902option smtpchk X - X X
1903option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1904option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1905option splice-request (*) X X X X
1906option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01001907option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001908option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1909option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1910-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001911option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001912option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1913option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1914option tcpka X X X X
1915option tcplog X X X X
1916option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001917external-check command X - X X
1918external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001919persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1920rate-limit sessions X X X -
1921redirect - X X X
1922redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1923redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1924reqadd - X X X
1925reqallow - X X X
1926reqdel - X X X
1927reqdeny - X X X
1928reqiallow - X X X
1929reqidel - X X X
1930reqideny - X X X
1931reqipass - X X X
1932reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001933reqitarpit - X X X
1934reqpass - X X X
1935reqrep - X X X
1936-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001937reqtarpit - X X X
1938retries X - X X
1939rspadd - X X X
1940rspdel - X X X
1941rspdeny - X X X
1942rspidel - X X X
1943rspideny - X X X
1944rspirep - X X X
1945rsprep - X X X
1946server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001947server-state-file-name X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001948source X - X X
1949srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02001950stats admin - X X X
1951stats auth X X X X
1952stats enable X X X X
1953stats hide-version X X X X
1954stats http-request - X X X
1955stats realm X X X X
1956stats refresh X X X X
1957stats scope X X X X
1958stats show-desc X X X X
1959stats show-legends X X X X
1960stats show-node X X X X
1961stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001962-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1963stick match - - X X
1964stick on - - X X
1965stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001966stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001967stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001968tcp-check connect - - X X
1969tcp-check expect - - X X
1970tcp-check send - - X X
1971tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001972tcp-request connection - X X -
1973tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001974tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02001975tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001976tcp-response content - - X X
1977tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001978timeout check X - X X
1979timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001980timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001981timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1982timeout connect X - X X
1983timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1984timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1985timeout http-request X X X X
1986timeout queue X - X X
1987timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001988timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001989timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1990timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001991timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001992transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001993unique-id-format X X X -
1994unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001995use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001996use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001997------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1998 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001999
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002000
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020014.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2002---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002003
2004This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2005
2006
2007acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2008 Declare or complete an access list.
2009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2010 no | yes | yes | yes
2011 Example:
2012 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2013 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2014 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002016 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002017
2018
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002019appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2020 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002021 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2023 no | no | yes | yes
2024 Arguments :
2025 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2026 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2027
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002028 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002029 checked in each cookie value.
2030
2031 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2032 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2033 milliseconds.
2034
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002035 request-learn
2036 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2037 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2038 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2039 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2040 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2041 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2042
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002043 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2044 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2045 data following this prefix.
2046
2047 Example :
2048 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2049
2050 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
2051 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
2052
2053 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2054 2 modes are currently supported :
2055 - path-parameters :
2056 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2057 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2058 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2059 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2060 - query-string :
2061 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2062 query string.
2063
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002064 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2065 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2066 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002067
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002068 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2069 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002070
2071
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002072backlog <conns>
2073 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2075 yes | yes | yes | no
2076 Arguments :
2077 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2078 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002079 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002080
2081 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2082 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2083 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2084 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2085 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2086 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2087 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2088 backlog parameter.
2089
2090 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2091 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2092 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2093
2094 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2095
2096
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002097balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002098balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002099 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2101 yes | no | yes | yes
2102 Arguments :
2103 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2104 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2105 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2106 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2107
2108 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2109 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2110 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2111 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002112 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002113 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002114 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2115 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2116 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2117 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2118 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2119 it, so that you don't worry.
2120
2121 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2122 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2123 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2124 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2125 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2126 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2127 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2128 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002129
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002130 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2131 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2132 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2133 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2134 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2135 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2136 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2137 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2138
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002139 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002140 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002141 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2142 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002143 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002144 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2145 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2146 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2147 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2148 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002149 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2150 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2151 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2152 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2153 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2154 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002155
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002156 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2157 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2158 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2159 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2160 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2161 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2162 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2163 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002164 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002165 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002166 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2167 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2168 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002169
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002170 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2171 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2172 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2173 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2174 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2175 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2176 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2177 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2178 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2179 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2180 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2181 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002182
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002183 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002184 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2185 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2186 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2187 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2188 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2189 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2190 URIs start with a leading "/".
2191
2192 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2193 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2194 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2195 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2196
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002197 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002198 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2199
2200 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002201 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2202 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002203 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2204 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2205 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2206 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002207 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002208 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2209 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002210
2211 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2212 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2213 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2214 server will receive the request.
2215
2216 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2217 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2218 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2219 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2220 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002221 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2222 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2223 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002224
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002225 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2226 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2227 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2228 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2229 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002230
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002231 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002232 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2233 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2234 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2235
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002236 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2237 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2238 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2239
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002240 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002241 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002242 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2243 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2244 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2245 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2246 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2247 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002248 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002249 used instead.
2250
2251 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2252 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2253 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2254 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2255
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002256 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2257 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2258 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2259
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002260 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002261
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002262 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002263 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2264 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002265
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002266 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2267 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2268 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002269
2270 Examples :
2271 balance roundrobin
2272 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002273 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002274 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2275 balance hdr(host)
2276 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002277
2278 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2279 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2280
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002281 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002282 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2283 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2284 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2285 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2286
2287 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2288 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2289 defaults to 16 kB.
2290
2291 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2292 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2293
2294 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2295 Round Robin.
2296
2297 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2298 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2299 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2300 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2301
2302 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2303
2304 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002305 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002306 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2307 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2308 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002309
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002310 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002311
2312
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002313bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2314bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002315 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2317 no | yes | yes | no
2318 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002319 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2320 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2321 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2322 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002323 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002324 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2325 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2326 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2327 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2328 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2329 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2330 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002331 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2332 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2333 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2334 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2335 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2336 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2337 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002338 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2339 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2340 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002341 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2342 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2343 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002344
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002345 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2346 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002347 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2348 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2349 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002350 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2351 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2352 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2353 the range.
2354
2355 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2356 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2357 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2358 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2359 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2360 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2361 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002362 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002363 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002364
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002365 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2366 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2367 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2368 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2369 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2370 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2371 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2372 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2373
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002374 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2375 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2376 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2377 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002378
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002379 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2380 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2381 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2382 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2383 in a frontend.
2384
2385 Example :
2386 listen http_proxy
2387 bind :80,:443
2388 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002389 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002390
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002391 listen http_https_proxy
2392 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002393 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002394
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002395 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2396 bind ipv6@:80
2397 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2398 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2399
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002400 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002401 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002402
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002403 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2404 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2405 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2406 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2407 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2408
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002409 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002410 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002411
2412
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002413bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002414 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2416 yes | yes | yes | yes
2417 Arguments :
2418 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2419 may be used to override a default value.
2420
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002421 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002422 option may be combined with other numbers.
2423
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002424 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002425 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2426 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2427 missing from all processes.
2428
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002429 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002430 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002431 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2432 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2433 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2434 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002435
2436 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2437 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2438 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2439 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2440 and 'even' instances.
2441
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002442 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2443 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2444 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2445 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002446
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002447 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2448 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2449
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002450 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2451 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2452 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2453
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002454 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2455 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2456
2457 Example :
2458 listen app_ip1
2459 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002460 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002461
2462 listen app_ip2
2463 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002464 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002465
2466 listen management
2467 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002468 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002469
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002470 listen management
2471 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2472 bind-process 1-4
2473
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002474 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002475
2476
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002477block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002478 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2480 no | yes | yes | yes
2481
2482 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2483 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002484 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002485 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002486 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2487 "block" statements per instance.
2488
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002489 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2490 "http-request deny" instead.
2491
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002492 Example:
2493 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2494 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2495 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2496 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2497
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002498 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002499
2500
2501capture cookie <name> len <length>
2502 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2504 no | yes | yes | no
2505 Arguments :
2506 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2507 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2508 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2509 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2510 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2511
2512 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2513 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2514 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2515 right if it exceeds <length>.
2516
2517 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2518 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2519 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2520 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2521
2522 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2523 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2524 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2525
2526 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2527 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2528 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002529 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2530 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2531 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002532
2533 Example:
2534 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2535
2536 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002537 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002538
2539
2540capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002541 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2543 no | yes | yes | no
2544 Arguments :
2545 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002546 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002547 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2548 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2549 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2550
2551 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2552 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2553 it exceeds <length>.
2554
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002555 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002556 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2557 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002558 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2559 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2560 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2561 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002562 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002563 environments to find where the request came from.
2564
2565 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2566 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2567 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2568 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002569
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002570 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2571 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2572 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2573 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2574 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002575
2576 Example:
2577 capture request header Host len 15
2578 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002579 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002580
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002581 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002582 about logging.
2583
2584
2585capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002586 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2588 no | yes | yes | no
2589 Arguments :
2590 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002591 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002592 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2593 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2594 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2595
2596 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2597 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2598 it exceeds <length>.
2599
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002600 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002601 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2602 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2603 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002604 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2605 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2606 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2607 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002608
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002609 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2610 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2611 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2612 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2613 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002614
2615 Example:
2616 capture response header Content-length len 9
2617 capture response header Location len 15
2618
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002619 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002620 about logging.
2621
2622
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002623clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002624 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2626 yes | yes | yes | no
2627 Arguments :
2628 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2629 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2630 as explained at the top of this document.
2631
2632 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2633 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2634 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2635 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2636 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2637 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2638 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2639 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002640 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002641 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2642 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2643
2644 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2645 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2646 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2647 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2648 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2649 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2650
2651 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2652 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2653
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002654 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2655 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002656
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002657compression algo <algorithm> ...
2658compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002659compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002660 Enable HTTP compression.
2661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2662 yes | yes | yes | yes
2663 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002664 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2665 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2666 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2667
2668 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002669 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2670 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2671 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002672
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002673 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002674 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002675
2676 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2677 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2678 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2679 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2680 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002681 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002682
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002683 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2684 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2685 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2686 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2687 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2688 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2689 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002690 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002691
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002692 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002693 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002694 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2695 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2696 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2697 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2698 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002699
2700 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2701 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2702 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2703 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2704 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002705 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2706 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2707 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2708 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2709 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002710 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2711 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002712
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002713 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002714 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2715 "Accept-Encoding" header
2716 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002717 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002718 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2719 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002720 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2721 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2722 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2723 "multipart"
2724 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2725 header
2726 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2727 and later
2728 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2729 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002730
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002731 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2732 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002733
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002734 Examples :
2735 compression algo gzip
2736 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002737
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002738
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002739contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002740 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2742 yes | no | yes | yes
2743 Arguments :
2744 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2745 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2746 as explained at the top of this document.
2747
2748 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002749 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002750 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002751 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2752 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2753 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2754 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2755
2756 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2757 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2758 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2759 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2760 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2761 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2762
2763 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2764 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2765 instead.
2766
2767 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2768 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2769
2770
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002771cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002772 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2773 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01002774 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002775 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2777 yes | no | yes | yes
2778 Arguments :
2779 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2780 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2781 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2782 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2783 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2784 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2785 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2786 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2787 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2788
2789 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2790 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2791 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2792 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2793 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2794 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002795 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2796 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2797 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2798 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2799 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002800
2801 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002802 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002803
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002804 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002805 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2806 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2807 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2808 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2809 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2810 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2811 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2812 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2813 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2814 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002815
2816 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2817 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2818 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2819 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2820 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2821 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2822 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2823 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2824 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002825 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002826 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2827 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2828 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002829
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002830 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2831 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2832 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002833 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2834 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2835 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2836 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002837 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2838 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2839 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002840
2841 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2842 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2843 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2844 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2845 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2846 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2847 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2848 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2849 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2850
2851 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2852 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2853 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2854 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2855 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2856 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2857 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2858 persistence cookie in the cache.
2859 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2860
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002861 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2862 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2863 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2864 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2865 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2866 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2867 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2868 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2869 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2870 they logout.
2871
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002872 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2873 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2874 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2875 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2876
2877 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2878 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2879 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2880 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2881 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2882 this attribute.
2883
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002884 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002885 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002886 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2887 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2888 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2889 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2890 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2891 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002892
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002893 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2894 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2895 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2896 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2897 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2898 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2899 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2900 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2901 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2902 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2903 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2904 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2905 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2906 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2907 the site.
2908
2909 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2910 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2911 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2912 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2913 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2914 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2915 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2916 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2917 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2918 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2919 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2920 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2921 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2922 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2923 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2924 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2925
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01002926 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
2927 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
2928 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
2929 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
2930 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
2931 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
2932
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002933 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2934 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2935 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2936 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002937
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002938 Examples :
2939 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2940 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2941 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002942 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002943
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002944 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002945
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002946
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002947declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2948 Declares a capture slot.
2949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2950 no | yes | yes | no
2951 Arguments:
2952 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2953
2954 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2955 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2956 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2957 for use in the response.
2958
2959 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02002960 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002961 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2962
2963
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002964default-server [param*]
2965 Change default options for a server in a backend
2966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2967 yes | no | yes | yes
2968 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002969 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2970 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2971 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2972 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002973
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002974 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002975 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2976
2977 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002978
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002979
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002980default_backend <backend>
2981 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2983 yes | yes | yes | no
2984 Arguments :
2985 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2986
2987 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2988 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2989 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2990 will catch all undetermined requests.
2991
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002992 Example :
2993
2994 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2995 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2996 default_backend dynamic
2997
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02002998 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002999
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003000
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003001description <string>
3002 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3004 no | yes | yes | yes
3005 Arguments : string
3006
3007 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3008 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3009 it describes.
3010 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3011
3012
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003013disabled
3014 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3015 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3016 yes | yes | yes | yes
3017 Arguments : none
3018
3019 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3020 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3021 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3022 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3023 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3024 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3025 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3026
3027 See also : "enabled"
3028
3029
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003030dispatch <address>:<port>
3031 Set a default server address
3032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3033 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003034 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003035
3036 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3037 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3038 during start-up.
3039
3040 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3041 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3042 possible with normal servers.
3043
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003044 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003045 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3046 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3047 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3048 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3049
3050 See also : "server"
3051
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003052
3053dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3054 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3056 yes | no | yes | yes
3057 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3058
3059 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
3060 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitely
3061 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3062 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
3063 That way, we can ensure session persistence accross multiple load-balancers,
3064 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003065
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003066enabled
3067 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3069 yes | yes | yes | yes
3070 Arguments : none
3071
3072 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3073 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3074
3075 See also : "disabled"
3076
3077
3078errorfile <code> <file>
3079 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3080 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3081 yes | yes | yes | yes
3082 Arguments :
3083 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04003084 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
3085 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003086
3087 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003088 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003089 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003090 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3091 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003092
3093 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3094 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3095 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3096
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003097 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3098
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003099 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3100 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3101 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3102 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3103
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003104 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3105 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
3106 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
3107 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3108 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3109 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3110
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003111 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3112 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3113 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003114 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003115 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3116
3117 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3118
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003119 Example :
3120 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003121 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003122 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3123 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3124
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003125
3126errorloc <code> <url>
3127errorloc302 <code> <url>
3128 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3130 yes | yes | yes | yes
3131 Arguments :
3132 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003133 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003134
3135 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3136 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3137 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3138 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3139 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3140
3141 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3142 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3143 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3144
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003145 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3146
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003147 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3148 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3149 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3150 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003151 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003152 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3153 request.
3154
3155 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3156
3157
3158errorloc303 <code> <url>
3159 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3161 yes | yes | yes | yes
3162 Arguments :
3163 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
3164 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3165
3166 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3167 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3168 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3169 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3170 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3171
3172 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3173 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3174 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3175
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003176 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3177
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003178 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3179 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3180 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3181 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003182 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003183
3184 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3185
3186
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003187email-alert from <emailaddr>
3188 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3189 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3190 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3191 yes | yes | yes | yes
3192
3193 Arguments :
3194
3195 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3196
3197 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3198 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3199
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003200 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003201 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3202 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003203
3204
3205email-alert level <level>
3206 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3207 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3208 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3209 yes | yes | yes | yes
3210
3211 Arguments :
3212
3213 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3214 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3215 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3216
3217 By default level is alert
3218
3219 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3220 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3221 for the proxy.
3222
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003223 Alerts are sent when :
3224
3225 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3226 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3227 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3228 is notice or lower
3229 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3230 and a health check status update occurs
3231
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003232 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3233 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003234 section 3.6 about mailers.
3235
3236
3237email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3238 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3239 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3240 yes | yes | yes | yes
3241
3242 Arguments :
3243
3244 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3245
3246 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3247 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3248
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003249 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3250 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003251
3252
3253email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3254 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3255 mailers.
3256 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3257 yes | yes | yes | yes
3258
3259 Arguments :
3260
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003261 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003262
3263 By default the systems hostname is used.
3264
3265 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3266 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3267 for the proxy.
3268
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003269 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3270 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003271
3272
3273email-alert to <emailaddr>
3274 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3275 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3276 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3277 yes | yes | yes | yes
3278
3279 Arguments :
3280
3281 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3282
3283 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3284 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3285
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003286 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003287 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3288
3289
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003290force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3291 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3292 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3293 no | yes | yes | yes
3294
3295 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3296 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3297 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3298 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3299 marked down for maintenance operations.
3300
3301 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3302 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3303 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3304 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3305 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3306 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3307 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3308 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3309 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3310
3311 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3312 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3313 is used.
3314
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003315 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003316 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003317
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003318
3319filter <name> [param*]
3320 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3322 no | yes | yes | yes
3323 Arguments :
3324 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3325 referenced in section 9.
3326
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003327 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003328 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003329 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3330 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003331
3332 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3333 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3334
3335 Example:
3336 listen
3337 bind *:80
3338
3339 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3340 filter compression
3341 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3342
3343 compression algo gzip
3344 compression offload
3345
3346 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3347
3348 See also : section 9.
3349
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003350
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003351fullconn <conns>
3352 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3354 yes | no | yes | yes
3355 Arguments :
3356 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3357 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3358
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003359 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003360 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003361 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003362 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3363 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3364 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3365 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3366 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003367 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003368
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003369 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3370 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003371 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3372 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3373 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003374
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003375 Example :
3376 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3377 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3378 # connections.
3379 backend dynamic
3380 fullconn 10000
3381 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3382 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3383
3384 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3385
3386
3387grace <time>
3388 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003390 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003391 Arguments :
3392 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3393 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3394 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3395
3396 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3397 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003398 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003399 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3400
3401 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3402 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3403 simplify it.
3404
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003405
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003406hash-balance-factor <factor>
3407 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3409 yes | no | no | yes
3410 Arguments :
3411 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3412 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3413 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3414
3415 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3416 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3417 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3418 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3419 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3420 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3421 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3422
3423 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3424 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3425 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3426 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3427 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3428
3429 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3430
3431
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003432hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003433 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3435 yes | no | yes | yes
3436 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003437 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3438 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003439
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003440 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3441 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3442 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3443 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3444 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3445 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3446 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3447 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3448 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3449 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003450
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003451 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3452 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3453 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3454 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3455 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3456 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3457 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3458 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3459 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3460 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3461 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3462 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3463 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003464 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3465 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003466
3467 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3468
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003469 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003470 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3471 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3472 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003473 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3474 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3475 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003476
3477 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3478 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003479 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3480 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3481 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3482 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3483
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003484 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3485 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3486 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3487 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3488 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3489 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3490 parameter.
3491
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003492 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3493 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3494 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3495 used on strings.
3496
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003497 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3498
3499 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3500 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3501 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3502 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3503 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3504 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3505 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3506 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3507 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3508 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3509 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3510 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003511
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003512 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3513 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3514 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003515
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003516 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003517
3518
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003519http-check disable-on-404
3520 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003522 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003523 Arguments : none
3524
3525 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3526 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3527 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3528 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3529 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3530 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3531 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3532 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003533 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3534 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3535 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3536
3537 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3538
3539
3540http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003541 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003543 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003544 Arguments :
3545 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3546 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003547 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003548 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3549 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3550 details on the supported keywords.
3551
3552 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3553 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3554 with the usual backslash ('\').
3555
3556 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3557 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3558 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3559 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3560 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3561
3562 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003563 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003564 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3565 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3566 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3567
3568 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003569 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003570 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3571 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3572 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3573 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3574
3575 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003576 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003577 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3578 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3579 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3580 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3581 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3582 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3583 trace).
3584
3585 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003586 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003587 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3588 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3589 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3590 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3591 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3592 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3593
3594 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3595 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3596 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3597 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3598 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3599 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3600 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3601 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3602
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003603 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3604 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3605 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3606
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003607 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3608 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3609
3610 Examples :
3611 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003612 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003613
3614 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003615 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003616
3617 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003618 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003619
3620 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003621 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003622
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003623 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003624
3625
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003626http-check send-state
3627 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3629 yes | no | yes | yes
3630 Arguments : none
3631
3632 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3633 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3634 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3635 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3636 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3637
3638 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3639 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3640 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3641 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3642 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003643 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3644 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3645 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3646
3647 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3648 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3649 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3650
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003651 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3652 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3653 checked in multiple backends.
3654
3655 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3656 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3657
3658 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3659 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3660 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3661 one fails.
3662
3663 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3664 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3665 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3666
3667 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3668 server's queue.
3669
3670 Example of a header received by the application server :
3671 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3672 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3673
3674 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3675
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003676http-request { allow | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
3677 tarpit [deny_status <status>] | deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003678 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003679 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003680 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003681 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3682 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003683 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3684 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003685 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3686 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3687 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003688 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003689 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01003690 unset-var(<var name>) |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003691 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003692 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003693 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003694 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003695 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003696 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003697 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3698
3699 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3700 no | yes | yes | yes
3701
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003702 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3703 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3704 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3705 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3706 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003707
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003708 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3709 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3710 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3711
3712 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003713 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3714 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3715 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3716 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003717
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003718 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3719 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3720 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003721 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status
3722 code specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003723 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3724 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3725 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3726 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3727 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003728 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003729 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3730 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003731
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003732 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3733 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3734 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3735 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3736 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3737
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003738 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3739 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3740 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003741 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3742 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003743
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003744 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3745 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3746 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3747 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3748 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3749 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3750 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3751 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3752
3753 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3754 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3755 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003756 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3757 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003758
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003759 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3760 <name>.
3761
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003762 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3763 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3764 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3765 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3766 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3767 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3768 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3769 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3770
3771 Example:
3772
3773 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3774
3775 applied to:
3776
3777 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3778
3779 outputs:
3780
3781 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3782
3783 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3784
3785 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3786 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3787 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3788 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3789 header.
3790
3791 Example:
3792
3793 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3794
3795 applied to:
3796
3797 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3798
3799 outputs:
3800
3801 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3802
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003803 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3804 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3805 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3806 it.
3807
3808 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3809 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3810 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3811 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3812 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3813 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3814
3815 Example :
3816 # prepend the host name before the path
3817 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3818
3819 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3820 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3821 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3822 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3823 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3824 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3825 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3826 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3827
3828 Example :
3829 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3830 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3831
3832 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3833 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3834 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3835 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3836 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3837 "set-query".
3838
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003839 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3840 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3841 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3842 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3843 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3844 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3845 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3846 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3847
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003848 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3849 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3850 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3851 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3852 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3853 another equipment.
3854
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003855 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3856 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3857 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3858 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3859 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3860 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3861 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3862 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3863
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003864 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3865 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3866 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3867 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3868 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3869 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3870 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3871 admin privileges.
3872
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003873 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3874 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3875 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3876 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3877 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3878 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3879 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3880 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3881
3882 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3883 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3884 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3885 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3886 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3887 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3888
3889 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3890 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3891 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3892 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3893 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3894 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3895
3896 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3897 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3898 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3899 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3900 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3901 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3902 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3903 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3904 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3905
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003906 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003907 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3908 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3909 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3910 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3911 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3912 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3913 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3914 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3915 request header" for more information.
3916
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003917 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3918 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3919 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3920 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01003921 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
3922 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003923
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003924 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3925 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3926 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3927 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3928 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3929 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3930 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3931 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3932 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3933 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3934 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3935 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3936
3937 These actions take one or two arguments :
3938 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3939 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3940 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3941 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3942
3943 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3944 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3945 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3946 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3947
3948 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3949 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3950 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3951 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3952 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3953 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3954 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3955 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3956
3957 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3958 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3959 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3960 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3961 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3962
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003963 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
3964 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
3965 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
3966 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
3967 continues.
3968
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003969 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
3970 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
3971 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
3972 the actions evaluation continues.
3973
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003974 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
3975 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3976 inline.
3977
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003978 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
3979 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003980 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003981 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
3982 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003983 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003984 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003985 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003986 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
3987 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003988 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003989 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003990 and '_'.
3991
3992 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3993 followed by some converters.
3994
3995 Example:
3996
3997 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
3998
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01003999 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4000 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4001
4002 Example:
4003
4004 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
4005
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004006 - set-src <expr> :
4007 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4008 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
4009 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4010 source IP for privacy.
4011
4012 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4013 followed by some converters.
4014
4015 Example:
4016
4017 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4018 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4019
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004020 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4021 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004022
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004023 - set-src-port <expr> :
4024 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4025 expression.
4026
4027 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4028 followed by some converters.
4029
4030 Example:
4031
4032 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4033 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4034
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004035 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
4036 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
4037 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004038
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004039 - set-dst <expr> :
4040 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4041 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
4042 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4043 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4044 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4045
4046 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4047 followed by some converters.
4048
4049 Example:
4050
4051 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4052 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
4053
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004054 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
4055 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
4056
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004057 - set-dst-port <expr> :
4058 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4059 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4060 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4061
4062 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4063 followed by some converters.
4064
4065 Example:
4066
4067 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4068 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
4069
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004070 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4071 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4072 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4073
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004074 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4075 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4076 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4077 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4078 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4079 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4080 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4081 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4082 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4083 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4084 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4085 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4086 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4087 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4088 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4089 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4090
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004091 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
4092
4093 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4094 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004095 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4096 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
4097
4098 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4099 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4100 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4101 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004102
4103 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004104 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4105 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4106 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004107
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004108 http-request allow if nagios
4109 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4110 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4111 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004112
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004113 Example:
4114 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004115 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004116
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004117 Example:
4118 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4119 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02004120 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004121 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4122 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4123 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4124 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4125 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4126 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
4127
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004128 Example:
4129 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4130 acl add path /addacl
4131 acl del path /delacl
4132
4133 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4134
4135 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4136 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
4137
4138 Example:
4139 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4140 acl setmap path /setmap
4141 acl delmap path /delmap
4142
4143 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4144
4145 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4146 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
4147
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004148 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4149 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004150
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004151http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004152 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004153 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004154 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
4155 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004156 set-status <status> [reason <str>] |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004157 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
4158 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4159 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4160 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01004161 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004162 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004163 unset-var(<var-name>) |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004164 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004165 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004166 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004167 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004168 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02004169 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004170 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4171
4172 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4173 no | yes | yes | yes
4174
4175 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4176 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4177 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4178 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4179 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4180 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4181
4182 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4183 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4184 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4185 current section.
4186
4187 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4188 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4189 rules are evaluated.
4190
4191 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4192 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4193 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4194 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4195 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4196 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4197 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4198
4199 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4200 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4201 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4202 external users.
4203
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004204 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4205 <name>.
4206
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004207 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4208 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4209 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4210 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4211 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4212 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4213 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4214 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4215
4216 Example:
4217
4218 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4219
4220 applied to:
4221
4222 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4223
4224 outputs:
4225
4226 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4227
4228 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4229
4230 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4231 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4232 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4233 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4234 header.
4235
4236 Example:
4237
4238 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4239
4240 applied to:
4241
4242 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4243
4244 outputs:
4245
4246 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4247
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004248 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004249 be an integer between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be
4250 provided defined by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code
4251 will be used as a fallback.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004252
4253 Example:
4254
4255 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4256 http-response set-status 431
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004257 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4258 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004259
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004260 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4261 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4262 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4263 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4264 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4265 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4266 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4267 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4268
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004269 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4270 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4271 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4272 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4273 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4274 another equipment.
4275
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004276 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4277 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4278 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4279 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4280 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4281 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4282 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4283 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4284
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004285 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4286 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4287 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4288 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4289 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4290 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4291 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4292 admin privileges.
4293
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004294 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4295 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4296 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4297 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4298 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4299 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4300 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4301 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4302
4303 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4304 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4305 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4306 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4307 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4308 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4309
4310 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4311 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4312 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4313 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4314 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4315 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4316
4317 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4318 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4319 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4320 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4321 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4322 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4323 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4324 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4325 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4326
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004327 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4328 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4329 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4330 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4331 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4332 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4333 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4334 response header" for more information.
4335
4336 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4337 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4338 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4339 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4340 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004341 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4342 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004343
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004344 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4345 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4346 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4347 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4348 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4349 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4350
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004351 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4352 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4353 inline.
4354
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004355 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4356 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004357 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004358 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4359 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004360 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004361 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004362 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004363 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4364 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004365 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01004366 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
4367 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004368
4369 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4370 followed by some converters.
4371
4372 Example:
4373
4374 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4375
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004376 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4377 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4378
4379 Example:
4380
4381 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4382
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004383 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4384 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4385 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4386 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
4387 use of samples in response (eg. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4388 Layer 6 (eg. ssl related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
4389 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4390
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004391 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4392 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4393 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4394 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4395 continues.
4396
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004397 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4398 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4399 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4400 the actions evaluation continues.
4401
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004402 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4403 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4404 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4405 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4406 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4407 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4408 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4409 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4410 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4411 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4412 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4413 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4414 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4415 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4416 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4417 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4418
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004419 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4420
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004421 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004422 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4423 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004424 rules.
4425
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004426 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4427 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4428 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4429 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4430
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004431 Example:
4432 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4433
4434 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4435
4436 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4437 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4438
4439 Example:
4440 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4441
4442 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4443
4444 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4445 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4446
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004447 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4448 ACL usage.
4449
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004450
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004451http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4452 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4453
4454 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4455 yes | no | yes | yes
4456
4457 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4458 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4459 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4460 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4461 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4462 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4463
4464 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4465
4466 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4467 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4468 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4469 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4470 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4471 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4472 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4473 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4474 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4475 not checking any request past the first one.
4476
4477 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4478 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4479 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4480 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4481 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4482 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4483 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4484
4485 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4486 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4487 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4488 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4489 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4490 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4491 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4492 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4493 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4494 downsides of rare connection failures.
4495
4496 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4497 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4498 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4499 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4500 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4501 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4502 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4503 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4504 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4505 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4506 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4507 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4508
4509 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4510 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4511 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4512 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4513
4514 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4515 and are never shared ;
4516
4517 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4518 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4519 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4520 and are never shared ;
4521
4522 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4523 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4524 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4525
4526 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4527 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4528 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4529
4530 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4531
4532
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004533http-send-name-header [<header>]
4534 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4535
4536 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4537 yes | no | yes | yes
4538
4539 Arguments :
4540
4541 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4542
4543 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4544 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4545 is added with the header string proved.
4546
4547 See also : "server"
4548
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004549id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004550 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4552 no | yes | yes | yes
4553 Arguments : none
4554
4555 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4556 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4557 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004558
4559
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004560ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4561 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4562 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4563 no | yes | yes | yes
4564
4565 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4566 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4567 and running).
4568
4569 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4570 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4571 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004572 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004573 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4574
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004575 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4576 "unless" condition is met.
4577
4578 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4579
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004580load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4581 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4582 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4583 yes | no | yes | yes
4584
4585 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4586 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4587 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4588 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4589 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4590 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4591 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4592 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4593
4594 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4595 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02004596 9.2 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004597
4598 Arguments:
4599 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4600 named "server-state-file".
4601
4602 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4603 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4604 name is used as a file name.
4605
4606 none don't load any stat for this backend
4607
4608 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01004609 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
4610 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
4611 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
4612 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (eg: /etc/hosts)
4613 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004614
4615 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4616 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4617
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004618 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004619
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004620 global
4621 stats socket /tmp/socket
4622 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004623
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004624 defaults
4625 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004626
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004627 backend bk
4628 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4629 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004630
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004631
4632 Then one can run :
4633
4634 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4635
4636 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4637
4638 1
4639 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4640 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4641 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4642
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004643 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004644
4645 global
4646 stats socket /tmp/socket
4647 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4648
4649 defaults
4650 load-server-state-from-file local
4651
4652 backend bk
4653 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4654 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4655
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004656
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004657 Then one can run :
4658
4659 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4660
4661 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4662
4663 1
4664 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4665 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4666 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4667
4668 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4669 "show servers state"
4670
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004671
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004672log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004673log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004674no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004675 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4677 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004678
4679 Prefix :
4680 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4681 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4682 prefix does not allow arguments.
4683
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004684 Arguments :
4685 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4686 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4687 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4688 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4689 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4690 parameter.
4691
4692 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4693 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4694
4695 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4696 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4697 standard syslog port).
4698
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004699 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4700 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4701 standard syslog port).
4702
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004703 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4704 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4705 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4706 appropriately writeable).
4707
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004708 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4709 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004710
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004711 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4712 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4713 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4714 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4715 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4716 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4717 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4718 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4719 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4720 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4721 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4722
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004723 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4724
4725 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4726 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4727 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4728
4729 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4730 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4731 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004732 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4733 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4734 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4735 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4736 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004737
4738 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4739
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004740 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4741 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4742 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004743
4744 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4745 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4746 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4747 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4748
4749 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4750 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004751
4752 Example :
4753 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004754 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4755 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004756 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004757
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004758
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004759log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004760 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4761 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4762 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004763
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004764 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4765 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4766 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4767 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4768 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004769
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004770log-format-sd <string>
4771 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4772 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4773 yes | yes | yes | no
4774
4775 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4776 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4777 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4778 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4779 which covers the log format string in depth.
4780
4781 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4782 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4783
4784 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4785 log format to "rfc5424".
4786
4787 Example :
4788 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4789
4790
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004791log-tag <string>
4792 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4793 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4794 yes | yes | yes | yes
4795
4796 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4797 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4798 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4799 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4800 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4801 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4802 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4803 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4804 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004805
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004806max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4807 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4808 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4809 yes | no | yes | yes
4810
4811 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4812 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4813 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4814 servers.
4815
4816 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4817 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4818 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4819 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4820 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4821 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4822 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4823 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4824 picking a different server.
4825
4826 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4827 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4828 even if they have to be queued.
4829
4830 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4831 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4832
4833
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004834maxconn <conns>
4835 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4837 yes | yes | yes | no
4838 Arguments :
4839 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4840 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4841 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4842 closes.
4843
4844 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4845 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4846 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4847 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01004848 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
4849 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
4850 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
4851 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004852
4853 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4854 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4855 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4856
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004857 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4858
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004859 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4860
4861
4862mode { tcp|http|health }
4863 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4865 yes | yes | yes | yes
4866 Arguments :
4867 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4868 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4869 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4870 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4871
4872 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4873 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4874 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4875 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4876 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4877
4878 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004879 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4880 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4881 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4882 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4883 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4884 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4885 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004886
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004887 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4888 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4889 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004890
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004891 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004892 defaults http_instances
4893 mode http
4894
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004895 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004896
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004897
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004898monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004899 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4901 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004902 Arguments :
4903 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4904 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004905 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004906 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4907 backend and its backup.
4908
4909 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4910 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4911 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4912 servers in a list of backends.
4913
4914 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4915 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4916 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4917 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4918 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4919 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4920 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004921 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4922 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004923
4924 Example:
4925 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004926 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004927 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4928 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4929 monitor-uri /site_alive
4930 monitor fail if site_dead
4931
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004932 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004933
4934
4935monitor-net <source>
4936 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4938 yes | yes | yes | no
4939 Arguments :
4940 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4941 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4942 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4943 followed by a mask.
4944
4945 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4946 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004947 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004948 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4949
4950 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4951 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4952 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4953 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004954 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4955 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4956 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004957
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004958 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4959 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4960 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4961 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4962 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4963 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004964
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004965 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4966 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004967
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004968 Example :
4969 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4970 frontend www
4971 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4972
4973 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4974
4975
4976monitor-uri <uri>
4977 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4979 yes | yes | yes | no
4980 Arguments :
4981 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4982 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4983
4984 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4985 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4986 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4987 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4988 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4989 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4990 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4991 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4992
4993 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4994 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4995 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4996 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4997 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4998 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4999
5000 Example :
5001 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5002 frontend www
5003 mode http
5004 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5005
5006 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5007
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005008
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005009option abortonclose
5010no option abortonclose
5011 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5013 yes | no | yes | yes
5014 Arguments : none
5015
5016 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5017 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5018 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5019 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005020 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005021 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5022 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5023 encountered while delivering the response.
5024
5025 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5026 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5027 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5028 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5029 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5030 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005031 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005032 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005033 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005034 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5035 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5036 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5037
5038 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
5039 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
5040 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5041 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5042 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5043 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5044 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5045 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005046 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005047
5048 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5049 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5050
5051 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5052
5053
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005054option accept-invalid-http-request
5055no option accept-invalid-http-request
5056 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5058 yes | yes | yes | no
5059 Arguments : none
5060
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005061 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005062 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5063 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5064 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5065 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5066 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5067 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5068 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005069 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5070 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5071 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5072 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
5073 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005074 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005075 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5076 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5077 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005078
5079 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5080 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5081 been confirmed.
5082
5083 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5084 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005085 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5086 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005087 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5088
5089 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5090 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5091
5092 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5093 stats socket.
5094
5095
5096option accept-invalid-http-response
5097no option accept-invalid-http-response
5098 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5100 yes | no | yes | yes
5101 Arguments : none
5102
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005103 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005104 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5105 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5106 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5107 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5108 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5109 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5110 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005111 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5112 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5113 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005114
5115 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5116 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5117 been confirmed.
5118
5119 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5120 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5121 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5122 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5123
5124 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5125 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5126
5127 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5128 stats socket.
5129
5130
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005131option allbackups
5132no option allbackups
5133 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5135 yes | no | yes | yes
5136 Arguments : none
5137
5138 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5139 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5140 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5141 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5142 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5143 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5144 order between the backup servers anymore.
5145
5146 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5147 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5148
5149 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5150 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5151
5152
5153option checkcache
5154no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005155 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5157 yes | no | yes | yes
5158 Arguments : none
5159
5160 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5161 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005162 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005163 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5164 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005165 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005166
5167 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005168 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005169 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005170 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5171 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005172 to the client are :
5173 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005174 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005175 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005176 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
5177 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
5178 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5179 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5180 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5181 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5182 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5183 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5184 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5185 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5186 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5187
5188 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005189 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005190 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005191 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005192 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5193
5194 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5195 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005196 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005197 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
5198
5199 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5200 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5201
5202
5203option clitcpka
5204no option clitcpka
5205 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5207 yes | yes | yes | no
5208 Arguments : none
5209
5210 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5211 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5212 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5213 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5214
5215 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5216 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5217 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5218 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5219
5220 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5221 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5222 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5223 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5224 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5225
5226 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5227
5228 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5229 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5230 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5231
5232 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5233 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5234
5235 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5236
5237
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005238option contstats
5239 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5241 yes | yes | yes | no
5242 Arguments : none
5243
5244 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5245 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5246 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5247 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005248 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5249 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5250 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5251 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5252 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005253
5254
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005255option dontlog-normal
5256no option dontlog-normal
5257 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5259 yes | yes | yes | no
5260 Arguments : none
5261
5262 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5263 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5264 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5265 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5266 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5267 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5268 logged.
5269
5270 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5271 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5272 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5273
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005274 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005275 logging.
5276
5277
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005278option dontlognull
5279no option dontlognull
5280 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5282 yes | yes | yes | no
5283 Arguments : none
5284
5285 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5286 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5287 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5288 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5289 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5290 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005291 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5292 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5293 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005294
5295 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5296 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5297 would not be logged.
5298
5299 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5300 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5301
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005302 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5303 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005304
5305
5306option forceclose
5307no option forceclose
5308 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005310 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005311 Arguments : none
5312
5313 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5314 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5315 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5316 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5317 global session times in the logs.
5318
5319 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005320 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005321 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005322
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005323 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5324 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5325 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5326
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005327 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5328 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005329
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005330 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5331 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5332
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005333 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005334
5335
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005336option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005337 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5339 yes | yes | yes | yes
5340 Arguments :
5341 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5342 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005343 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005344 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005345
5346 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5347 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5348 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5349 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5350 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5351 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5352 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005353 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5354 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5355 possible that the client has already brought one.
5356
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005357 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005358 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005359 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5360 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005361 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5362 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005363
5364 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5365 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5366 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5367 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5368 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5369 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5370 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5371
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005372 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5373 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5374 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5375 are under the control of the end-user.
5376
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005377 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005378 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5379 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005380 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5381 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5382 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005383
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005384 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005385 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5386 frontend www
5387 mode http
5388 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5389
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005390 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5391 backend www
5392 mode http
5393 option forwardfor header X-Client
5394
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005395 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005396 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005397
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005398
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005399option http-buffer-request
5400no option http-buffer-request
5401 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5403 yes | yes | yes | yes
5404 Arguments : none
5405
5406 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5407 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5408 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5409 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5410 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5411 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5412 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5413 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005414 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005415 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5416 default.
5417
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005418 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005419
5420
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005421option http-ignore-probes
5422no option http-ignore-probes
5423 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5425 yes | yes | yes | no
5426 Arguments : none
5427
5428 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5429 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5430 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5431 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5432 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5433 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5434 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5435 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5436 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5437 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5438 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5439 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5440
5441 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5442 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5443 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5444 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5445 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5446 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5447 are often the only way to detect them.
5448
5449 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5450 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5451
5452 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5453
5454
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005455option http-keep-alive
5456no option http-keep-alive
5457 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5459 yes | yes | yes | yes
5460 Arguments : none
5461
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005462 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5463 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5464 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5465 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5466 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5467 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5468 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5469
5470 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5471 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005472 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5473 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5474 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5475 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5476 situations where this option may be useful :
5477
5478 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5479 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5480
5481 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5482 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5483
5484 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5485 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5486 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5487 request.
5488
5489 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5490 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005491 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5492 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5493 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005494
5495 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5496 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5497
5498 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5499 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5500 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5501 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5502 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5503 not set.
5504
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005505 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5506 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005507 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005508 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005509
5510 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005511 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5512 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005513
5514
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005515option http-no-delay
5516no option http-no-delay
5517 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5519 yes | yes | yes | yes
5520 Arguments : none
5521
5522 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5523 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5524 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5525 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5526 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5527 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5528 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5529 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5530 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5531 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5532 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5533 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5534 affected.
5535
5536 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5537 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5538 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5539 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5540 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5541 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5542 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5543 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5544 latency environments.
5545
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005546 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5547
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005548
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005549option http-pretend-keepalive
5550no option http-pretend-keepalive
5551 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5553 yes | yes | yes | yes
5554 Arguments : none
5555
5556 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5557 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5558 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5559 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5560 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5561 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5562 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5563 consider the response complete.
5564
5565 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5566 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5567 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5568 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5569 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5570 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5571
5572 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5573 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5574 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5575 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5576 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5577 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5578 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5579
5580 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5581 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005582 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005583 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5584 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005585
5586 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5587 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5588
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005589 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5590 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005591
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005592
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005593option http-server-close
5594no option http-server-close
5595 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5597 yes | yes | yes | yes
5598 Arguments : none
5599
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005600 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5601 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5602 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5603 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5604 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5605 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5606 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5607 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5608 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5609 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5610 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
5611 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
5612 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5613 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5614 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5615 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005616
5617 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5618 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5619 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5620 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005621 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5622 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005623
5624 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5625 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005626 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5627 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005628 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5629 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005630
5631 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5632 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5633
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005634 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005635 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5636 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005637
5638
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005639option http-tunnel
5640no option http-tunnel
5641 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5643 yes | yes | yes | yes
5644 Arguments : none
5645
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005646 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5647 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5648 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5649 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5650 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5651 "option http-tunnel".
5652
5653 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005654 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005655 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5656 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5657 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5658 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5659 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5660 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5661 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005662
5663 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5664 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5665
5666 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5667 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5668 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5669
5670
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005671option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005672no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005673 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5674 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5675 yes | yes | yes | no
5676 Arguments : none
5677
5678 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
5679 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5680 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5681 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5682 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5683 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5684 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5685
5686 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5687 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005688 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5689 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5690 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005691
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005692 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5693 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5694 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5695 front of an existing proxy.
5696
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005697 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5698
5699 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5700 http-server-close".
5701
5702
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005703option httpchk
5704option httpchk <uri>
5705option httpchk <method> <uri>
5706option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5707 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5709 yes | no | yes | yes
5710 Arguments :
5711 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5712 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5713 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5714 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5715 ones.
5716
5717 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5718 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5719 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5720
5721 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5722 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5723 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5724 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5725 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5726
5727 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5728 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5729 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5730 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5731 the lack of any response.
5732
5733 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5734
5735 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5736 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5737 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5738
5739 Examples :
5740 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5741 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5742 backend https_relay
5743 mode tcp
5744 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5745 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5746
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005747 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5748 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5749 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005750
5751
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005752option httpclose
5753no option httpclose
5754 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5756 yes | yes | yes | yes
5757 Arguments : none
5758
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005759 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5760 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5761 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5762 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005763 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005764 "option http-tunnel".
5765
5766 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5767 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5768 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5769 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5770 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5771 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5772 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5773 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005774
5775 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005776 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005777 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5778 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5779 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5780 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5781 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005782
5783 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5784 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005785 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5786 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005787 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5788 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005789
5790 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5791 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5792
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005793 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5794 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005795
5796
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005797option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005798 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5800 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005801 Arguments :
5802 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5803 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5804 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5805 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5806 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005807
5808 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5809 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5810 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5811 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5812 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5813 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5814 ports.
5815
5816 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5817
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005818 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5819 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005820
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005821 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005822
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005823
5824option http_proxy
5825no option http_proxy
5826 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5828 yes | yes | yes | yes
5829 Arguments : none
5830
5831 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5832 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5833 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5834 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5835 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5836
5837 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5838 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005839 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
5840 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005841
5842 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5843 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5844
5845 Example :
5846 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5847 backend direct_forward
5848 option httpclose
5849 option http_proxy
5850
5851 See also : "option httpclose"
5852
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005853
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005854option independent-streams
5855no option independent-streams
5856 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5858 yes | yes | yes | yes
5859 Arguments : none
5860
5861 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5862 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5863 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5864 receive data or not.
5865
5866 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5867 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5868 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5869 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5870 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5871 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5872 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5873 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5874 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5875 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5876 socket buffers.
5877
5878 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5879 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5880 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5881 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5882 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5883
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005884 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005885 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5886 deprecated.
5887
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005888 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005889
5890
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005891option ldap-check
5892 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5894 yes | no | yes | yes
5895 Arguments : none
5896
5897 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5898 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5899 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5900 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5901
5902 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5903 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5904
5905 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5906 configure it.
5907
5908 Example :
5909 option ldap-check
5910
5911 See also : "option httpchk"
5912
5913
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005914option external-check
5915 Use external processes for server health checks
5916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5917 yes | no | yes | yes
5918
5919 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5920 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5921 command".
5922
5923 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5924
5925 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5926
5927
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005928option log-health-checks
5929no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005930 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5932 yes | no | yes | yes
5933 Arguments : none
5934
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005935 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5936 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5937 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005938
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005939 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5940 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5941 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5942 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5943 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5944
5945 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5946 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005947
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005948 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5949 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5950 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005951
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005952
5953option log-separate-errors
5954no option log-separate-errors
5955 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5956 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5957 yes | yes | yes | no
5958 Arguments : none
5959
5960 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5961 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5962 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5963 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5964 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5965 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5966 provides very important information.
5967
5968 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5969 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5970 error logs.
5971
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005972 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005973 logging.
5974
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005975
5976option logasap
5977no option logasap
5978 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5980 yes | yes | yes | no
5981 Arguments : none
5982
5983 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
5984 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
5985 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
5986 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
5987 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
5988 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
5989 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005990 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005991 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
5992 bytes are expected to be transferred.
5993
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005994 Examples :
5995 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
5996 mode http
5997 option httplog
5998 option logasap
5999 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6000
6001 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6002 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6003 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6004 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6005
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006006 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006007 logging.
6008
6009
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006010option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006011 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6013 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006014 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006015 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6016 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006017 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006018
6019 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6020 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
6021 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
6022 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6023 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6024 in the MySQL table, like this :
6025
6026 USE mysql;
6027 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6028 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6029
6030 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
6031 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
6032 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6033 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6034 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6035 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6036 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6037 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6038 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6039
6040 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6041 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006042
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006043 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006044
6045 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6046 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6047 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6048 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006049 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6050 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006051
6052 See also: "option httpchk"
6053
6054
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006055option nolinger
6056no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006057 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006058 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6059 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006060 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006061
6062 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
6063 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6064 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6065 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6066 connections.
6067
6068 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6069 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6070 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6071 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6072 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6073 this too.
6074
6075 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6076 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6077 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6078
6079 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6080 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6081 for servers.
6082
6083 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6084 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6085
6086
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006087option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6088 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6090 yes | yes | yes | yes
6091 Arguments :
6092 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6093 matching <network>
6094 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6095 header name.
6096
6097 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6098 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6099 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6100 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6101 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6102 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6103 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6104 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6105 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6106 possible that the client has already brought one.
6107
6108 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6109 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6110 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6111 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6112 header and requires different one.
6113
6114 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6115 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6116 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6117 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6118 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6119 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6120 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6121
6122 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6123 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6124 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6125 both are defined.
6126
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006127 Examples :
6128 # Original Destination address
6129 frontend www
6130 mode http
6131 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6132
6133 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6134 backend www
6135 mode http
6136 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6137
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006138 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6139 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006140
6141
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006142option persist
6143no option persist
6144 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6145 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6146 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006147 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006148
6149 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6150 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6151 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6152 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6153 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6154 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6155 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6156 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6157 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6158 redirected to another valid server.
6159
6160 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6161 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6162
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006163 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006164
6165
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006166option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6167 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6169 yes | no | yes | yes
6170 Arguments :
6171 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6172 PostgreSQL server.
6173
6174 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6175 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6176 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6177 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6178
6179 See also: "option httpchk"
6180
6181
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006182option prefer-last-server
6183no option prefer-last-server
6184 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6185 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6186 yes | no | yes | yes
6187 Arguments : none
6188
6189 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6190 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6191 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6192 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6193 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6194 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6195 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6196 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6197 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006198 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6199 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6200 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6201 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6202 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6203 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6204 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006205
6206 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6207 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6208
6209 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6210
6211
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006212option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006213option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006214no option redispatch
6215 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6216 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6217 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006218 Arguments :
6219 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6220 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6221 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
6222 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
6223 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
6224 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
6225 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6226 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6227 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6228
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006229
6230 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6231 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6232 be able to access the service anymore.
6233
6234 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6235 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6236
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006237 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006238 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6239 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006240
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006241 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6242 "redisp" keywords.
6243
6244 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6245 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6246
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006247 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006248
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006249
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006250option redis-check
6251 Use redis health checks for server testing
6252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6253 yes | no | yes | yes
6254 Arguments : none
6255
6256 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6257 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6258 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6259 find the "+PONG" response message.
6260
6261 Example :
6262 option redis-check
6263
6264 See also : "option httpchk"
6265
6266
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006267option smtpchk
6268option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6269 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6271 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006272 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006273 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6274 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6275 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6276
6277 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6278 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6279 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6280
6281 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6282 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6283 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6284 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6285 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6286 dead server.
6287
6288 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6289 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6290 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6291 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6292
6293 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6294 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6295 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6296 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006297 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006298
6299 Example :
6300 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6301
6302 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6303
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006304
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006305option socket-stats
6306no option socket-stats
6307
6308 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6310 yes | yes | yes | no
6311
6312 Arguments : none
6313
6314
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006315option splice-auto
6316no option splice-auto
6317 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6319 yes | yes | yes | yes
6320 Arguments : none
6321
6322 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6323 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6324 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6325 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006326 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006327 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6328 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6329 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6330 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6331
6332 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6333 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6334 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6335 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6336 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6337 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6338 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6339 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6340 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6341 keyword.
6342
6343 Example :
6344 option splice-auto
6345
6346 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6347 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6348
6349 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6350 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6351
6352
6353option splice-request
6354no option splice-request
6355 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6357 yes | yes | yes | yes
6358 Arguments : none
6359
6360 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006361 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006362 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6363 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6364 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6365 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6366
6367 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6368
6369 Example :
6370 option splice-request
6371
6372 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6373 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6374
6375 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6376 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6377
6378
6379option splice-response
6380no option splice-response
6381 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6383 yes | yes | yes | yes
6384 Arguments : none
6385
6386 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006387 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006388 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6389 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6390 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6391 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6392
6393 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6394
6395 Example :
6396 option splice-response
6397
6398 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6399 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6400
6401 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6402 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6403
6404
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006405option spop-check
6406 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6408 no | no | no | yes
6409 Arguments : none
6410
6411 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6412 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6413 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6414 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6415
6416 Example :
6417 option spop-check
6418
6419 See also : "option httpchk"
6420
6421
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006422option srvtcpka
6423no option srvtcpka
6424 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6426 yes | no | yes | yes
6427 Arguments : none
6428
6429 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6430 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6431 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6432 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6433
6434 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6435 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6436 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6437 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6438
6439 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6440 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6441 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6442 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6443 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6444
6445 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6446
6447 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6448 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6449 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6450
6451 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6452 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6453
6454 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6455
6456
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006457option ssl-hello-chk
6458 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6460 yes | no | yes | yes
6461 Arguments : none
6462
6463 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6464 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6465 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6466 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6467 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6468 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6469 hello message.
6470
6471 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6472 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6473 messages, which is appreciable.
6474
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006475 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6476 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6477 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006478
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006479 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6480
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006481
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006482option tcp-check
6483 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6484 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6485 yes | no | yes | yes
6486
6487 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6488 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6489
6490 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6491 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6492 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6493
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006494 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006495 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6496 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6497 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6498 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6499 only.
6500
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006501 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006502 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6503 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6504 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6505 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6506
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006507 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006508 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6509 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006510 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006511 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6512 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6513 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6514 the respective protocols.
6515 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6516 analysed.
6517
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006518 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6519 script.
6520
6521 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6522 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6523 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6524 The "comment" is of course optional.
6525
6526
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006527 Examples :
6528 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6529 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006530 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006531
6532 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6533 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006534 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006535
6536 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6537 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006538 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006539 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006540 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006541 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006542 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006543 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006544 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6545 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006546 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006547 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6548 tcp-check expect string +OK
6549
6550 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6551 (send many headers before analyzing)
6552 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006553 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006554 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6555 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6556 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6557 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006558 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006559
6560
6561 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6562
6563
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006564option tcp-smart-accept
6565no option tcp-smart-accept
6566 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6568 yes | yes | yes | no
6569 Arguments : none
6570
6571 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6572 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6573 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6574 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6575 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6576 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6577
6578 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6579 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6580 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6581 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6582
6583 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6584 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6585 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6586 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6587
6588 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6589 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6590 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6591
6592 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6593 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6594 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6595
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006596 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6597
6598
6599option tcp-smart-connect
6600no option tcp-smart-connect
6601 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6603 yes | no | yes | yes
6604 Arguments : none
6605
6606 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6607 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6608 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6609 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6610 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6611
6612 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6613 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6614 complex.
6615
6616 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6617 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6618 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6619
6620 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6621 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6622
6623 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6624
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006625
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006626option tcpka
6627 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6629 yes | yes | yes | yes
6630 Arguments : none
6631
6632 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6633 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6634 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6635 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6636
6637 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6638 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6639 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6640 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6641
6642 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6643 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6644 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6645 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6646 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6647
6648 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6649
6650 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6651 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6652 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6653 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6654 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6655 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6656 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6657 backends.
6658
6659 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6660
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006661
6662option tcplog
6663 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6665 yes | yes | yes | yes
6666 Arguments : none
6667
6668 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6669 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6670 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6671 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6672 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6673 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6674 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6675 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6676
6677 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6678
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006679 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006680
6681
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006682option transparent
6683no option transparent
6684 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006686 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006687 Arguments : none
6688
6689 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6690 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6691 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6692 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6693 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6694 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6695 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6696 appropriate server.
6697
6698 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6699 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6700
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006701 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006702 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006703
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006704
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006705external-check command <command>
6706 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6708 yes | no | yes | yes
6709
6710 Arguments :
6711 <command> is the external command to run
6712
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006713 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6714
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006715 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006716
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006717 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6718 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6719 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6720 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6721 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6722 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006723
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006724 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6725
6726 Environment variables :
6727 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6728 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6729
6730 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6731
6732 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6733
6734 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6735 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6736 for a UNIX socket).
6737
6738 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6739
6740 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6741
6742 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6743
6744 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6745
6746 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6747
6748 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6749 socket).
6750
6751 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6752 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6753
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006754 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6755 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6756 failed.
6757
6758 Example :
6759 external-check command /bin/true
6760
6761 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6762
6763
6764external-check path <path>
6765 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6767 yes | no | yes | yes
6768
6769 Arguments :
6770 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6771
6772 The default path is "".
6773
6774 Example :
6775 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6776
6777 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6778 "external-check command"
6779
6780
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006781persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006782persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006783 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6785 yes | no | yes | yes
6786 Arguments :
6787 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006788 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6789 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006790
6791 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6792 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6793 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6794 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6795 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6796 forwarded to this server.
6797
6798 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6799 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6800 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006801 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006802 a single "listen" section.
6803
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006804 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6805 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6806 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6807
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006808 Example :
6809 listen tse-farm
6810 bind :3389
6811 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6812 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6813 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6814 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6815 persist rdp-cookie
6816 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006817 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006818 balance rdp-cookie
6819 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6820 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6821
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006822 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6823 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006824
6825
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006826rate-limit sessions <rate>
6827 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6829 yes | yes | yes | no
6830 Arguments :
6831 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6832 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6833
6834 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6835 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6836 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6837 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6838 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6839 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6840
6841 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6842 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6843 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6844 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6845
6846 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6847 listen smtp
6848 mode tcp
6849 bind :25
6850 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02006851 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006852
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006853 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6854 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6855 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006856
6857 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6858
6859
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006860redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6861redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6862redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006863 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6865 no | yes | yes | yes
6866
6867 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006868 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006869
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006870 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006871 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006872 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6873 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6874 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006875
6876 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6877 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6878 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6879 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6880 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006881 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6882 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6883 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6884 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006885
6886 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6887 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6888 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6889 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6890 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6891 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006892 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006893 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006894 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6895 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6896 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006897
6898 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006899 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6900 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6901 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02006902 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006903 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6904 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6905 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6906 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006907
6908 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6909 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6910
6911 - "drop-query"
6912 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6913 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6914 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6915 with a location-type redirect.
6916
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006917 - "append-slash"
6918 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6919 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6920 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6921 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6922
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006923 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6924 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6925 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6926 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6927 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6928 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6929 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6930
6931 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6932 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6933 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6934 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6935 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6936 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6937 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006938
6939 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6940 acl clear dst_port 80
6941 acl secure dst_port 8080
6942 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006943 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006944 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006945 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6946
6947 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006948 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6949 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6950 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006951 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006952
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006953 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6954 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6955 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6956
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006957 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006958 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006959
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006960 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02006961 http-request redirect code 301 location \
6962 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
6963 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006964
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006965 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006966
6967
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006968redisp (deprecated)
6969redispatch (deprecated)
6970 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6971 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6972 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006973 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006974
6975 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6976 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6977 be able to access the service anymore.
6978
6979 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
6980 redistribute them to a working server.
6981
6982 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
6983 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6984 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006985
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006986 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
6987 "option redispatch" instead.
6988
6989 See also : "option redispatch"
6990
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006991
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006992reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006993 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
6994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6995 no | yes | yes | yes
6996 Arguments :
6997 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6998 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006999 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007000
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007001 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7002 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7003
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007004 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7005 the last header of an HTTP request.
7006
7007 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7008 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7009 responses.
7010
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007011 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7012 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7013 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7014
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007015 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7016 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007017
7018
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007019reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7020reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007021 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7023 no | yes | yes | yes
7024 Arguments :
7025 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7026 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7027 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7028 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7029 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7030 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7031 ignores case.
7032
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007033 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7034 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7035
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007036 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7037 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7038 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7039 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007040 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007041
7042 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7043 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7044
7045 Example :
7046 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7047 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7048 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7049
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007050 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7051 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007052
7053
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007054reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7055reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007056 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7058 no | yes | yes | yes
7059 Arguments :
7060 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7061 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7062 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7063 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7064 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7065 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7066
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007067 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7068 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7069
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007070 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7071 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7072 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7073 next servers.
7074
7075 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7076 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7077 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7078
7079 Example :
7080 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7081 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7082 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7083
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007084 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7085 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007086
7087
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007088reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7089reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007090 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7092 no | yes | yes | yes
7093 Arguments :
7094 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7095 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7096 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7097 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7098 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7099 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7100 case.
7101
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007102 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7103 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7104
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007105 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7106 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7107 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7108 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007109 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007110
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007111 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007112 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007113 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007114
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007115 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7116 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7117
7118 Example :
7119 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7120 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7121 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7122
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007123 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7124 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007125
7126
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007127reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7128reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007129 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7131 no | yes | yes | yes
7132 Arguments :
7133 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7134 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7135 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7136 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7137 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7138 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7139 case.
7140
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007141 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7142 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7143
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007144 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7145 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7146 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7147 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7148
7149 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7150 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7151
7152 Example :
7153 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7154 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7155 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7156 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7157
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007158 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7159 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007160
7161
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007162reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7163reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007164 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7166 no | yes | yes | yes
7167 Arguments :
7168 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7169 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7170 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7171 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7172 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7173 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7174
7175 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7176 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7177 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7178 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007179 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007180
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007181 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7182 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7183
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007184 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7185 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7186 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7187
7188 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7189 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7190 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7191 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7192 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7193
7194 Example :
7195 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007196 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007197 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7198 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7199
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007200 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7201 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007202
7203
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007204reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7205reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007206 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7208 no | yes | yes | yes
7209 Arguments :
7210 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7211 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7212 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7213 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7214 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7215 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7216 ignores case.
7217
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007218 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7219 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7220
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007221 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7222 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007223 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7224 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7225 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007226 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7227 not set.
7228
7229 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7230 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7231 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7232 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7233 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7234
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007235 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007236 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
7237 # block all others.
7238 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7239 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7240
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007241 # block bad guys
7242 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7243 reqitarpit . if badguys
7244
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007245 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7246 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007247
7248
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007249retries <value>
7250 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7251 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7252 yes | no | yes | yes
7253 Arguments :
7254 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7255 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7256 default value is 3.
7257
7258 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7259 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7260 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7261
7262 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007263 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7264 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007265
7266 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7267 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7268
7269 See also : "option redispatch"
7270
7271
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007272rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007273 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7275 no | yes | yes | yes
7276 Arguments :
7277 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7278 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007279 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007280
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007281 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7282 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7283
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007284 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7285 the last header of an HTTP response.
7286
7287 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7288 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7289 responses.
7290
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007291 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7292 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007293
7294
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007295rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7296rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007297 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7299 no | yes | yes | yes
7300 Arguments :
7301 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7302 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7303 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7304 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7305 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7306 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7307 ignores case.
7308
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007309 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7310 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7311
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007312 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7313 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007314 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007315 client.
7316
7317 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7318 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7319 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7320
7321 Example :
7322 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007323 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007324
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007325 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7326 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007327
7328
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007329rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7330rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007331 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7333 no | yes | yes | yes
7334 Arguments :
7335 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7336 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7337 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7338 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7339 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7340 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7341 ignores case.
7342
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007343 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7344 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7345
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007346 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7347 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7348 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7349 case-sensitive.
7350
7351 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007352 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7353 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7354 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007355
7356 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7357 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7358
7359 Example :
7360 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7361 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7362
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007363 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7364 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007365
7366
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007367rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7368rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007369 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7371 no | yes | yes | yes
7372 Arguments :
7373 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7374 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7375 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7376 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7377 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7378 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7379 ignores case.
7380
7381 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7382 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7383 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7384 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007385 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007386
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007387 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7388 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7389
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007390 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7391 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7392 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7393
7394 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7395 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7396 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7397 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7398 are not case-sensitive.
7399
7400 Example :
7401 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7402 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7403
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007404 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7405 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007406
7407
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007408server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007409 Declare a server in a backend
7410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7411 no | no | yes | yes
7412 Arguments :
7413 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007414 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007415 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007416
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007417 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7418 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7419 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7420 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007421 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7422 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7423 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7424 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7425 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007426 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7427 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7428 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7429 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7430 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7431 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7432 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007433 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007434 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7435 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007436 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7437 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007438
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007439 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007440 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7441 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7442 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7443 adding this value to the client's port.
7444
7445 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7446 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007447 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007448
7449 Examples :
7450 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7451 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007452 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007453 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7454 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7455 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007456
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007457 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7458 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7459 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7460 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7461 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7462
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007463 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7464 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007465
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007466server-state-file-name [<file>]
7467 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7468 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7469 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7470 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7471 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7472 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7473
7474 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7475 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7476
7477 global
7478 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7479
7480 backend bk
7481 load-server-state-from-file
7482
7483 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7484 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007485
7486source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007487source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007488source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007489 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7490 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7491 yes | no | yes | yes
7492 Arguments :
7493 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7494 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007495
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007496 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007497 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7498 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7499 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7500 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7501 supported prefixes are :
7502 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7503 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7504 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007505 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007506 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7507 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007508
7509 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7510 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007511 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7512 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7513 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007514
7515 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7516 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7517 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7518 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7519 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7520 <addr>.
7521
7522 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7523 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7524 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7525 port.
7526
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007527 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7528 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7529 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7530 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007531 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007532 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7533 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7534 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7535 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7536 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7537 HTTP header.
7538
7539 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7540 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007541 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007542 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7543 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7544 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7545 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7546 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7547 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7548 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7549
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007550 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7551 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7552 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7553 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7554 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7555 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7556
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007557 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7558 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7559 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7560 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7561
7562 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7563 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7564 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7565 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7566 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7567 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7568
7569 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7570 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7571 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7572 there are two methods :
7573
7574 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7575 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7576 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7577 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7578 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7579 of the client ranges may be used.
7580
7581 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7582 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7583 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7584 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7585 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7586 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7587 same session.
7588
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007589 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7590 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7591 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007592 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007593
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007594 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7595
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007596 Examples :
7597 backend private
7598 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7599 source 192.168.1.200
7600
7601 backend transparent_ssl1
7602 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7603 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7604
7605 backend transparent_ssl2
7606 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7607 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7608 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7609
7610 backend transparent_ssl3
7611 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7612 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7613 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7614
7615 backend transparent_smtp
7616 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7617 # with Tproxy version 4.
7618 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7619
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007620 backend transparent_http
7621 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7622 # proxy.
7623 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7624
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007625 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007626 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7627
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007628
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007629srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7630 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7632 yes | no | yes | yes
7633 Arguments :
7634 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7635 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7636 as explained at the top of this document.
7637
7638 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7639 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7640 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7641 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7642 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7643 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7644 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7645
7646 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7647 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7648 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7649 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7650 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007651 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007652 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007653 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007654
7655 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7656 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7657 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7658 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7659 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7660 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7661
7662 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7663 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7664
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007665 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7666 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007667
7668
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007669stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7670 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007672 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007673
7674 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7675 matched.
7676
7677 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7678 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7679
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007680 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7681 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7682 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7683
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007684 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7685 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7686 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7687 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007688
7689 Example :
7690 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7691 backend stats_localhost
7692 stats enable
7693 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7694
7695 Example :
7696 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7697 backend stats_auth
7698 stats enable
7699 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7700 stats admin if TRUE
7701
7702 Example :
7703 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7704 userlist stats-auth
7705 group admin users admin
7706 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7707 group readonly users haproxy
7708 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7709
7710 backend stats_auth
7711 stats enable
7712 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7713 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7714 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7715 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7716
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007717 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7718 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7719 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007720
7721
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007722stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7723 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007725 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007726 Arguments :
7727 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7728
7729 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7730
7731 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7732 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7733 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7734 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7735 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7736 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7737
7738 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7739 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7740 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007741 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007742
7743 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7744 report using "stats scope".
7745
7746 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7747 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7748 unobvious parameters.
7749
7750 Example :
7751 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7752 backend public_www
7753 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7754 stats enable
7755 stats hide-version
7756 stats scope .
7757 stats uri /admin?stats
7758 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7759 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7760 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7761
7762 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7763 backend private_monitoring
7764 stats enable
7765 stats uri /admin?stats
7766 stats refresh 5s
7767
7768 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7769
7770
7771stats enable
7772 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007774 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007775 Arguments : none
7776
7777 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7778 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7779 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7780 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7781 - stats auth : no authentication
7782 - stats scope : no restriction
7783
7784 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7785 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7786 unobvious parameters.
7787
7788 Example :
7789 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7790 backend public_www
7791 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7792 stats enable
7793 stats hide-version
7794 stats scope .
7795 stats uri /admin?stats
7796 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7797 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7798 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7799
7800 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7801 backend private_monitoring
7802 stats enable
7803 stats uri /admin?stats
7804 stats refresh 5s
7805
7806 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7807
7808
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007809stats hide-version
7810 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007812 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007813 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007814
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007815 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7816 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7817 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7818 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7819 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7820 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007821
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007822 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7823 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7824 unobvious parameters.
7825
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007826 Example :
7827 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7828 backend public_www
7829 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007830 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007831 stats hide-version
7832 stats scope .
7833 stats uri /admin?stats
7834 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7835 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7836 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007837
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007838 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7839 backend private_monitoring
7840 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007841 stats uri /admin?stats
7842 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007843
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007844 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007845
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007846
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007847stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7848 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7849 Access control for statistics
7850
7851 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7852 no | no | yes | yes
7853
7854 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7855 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7856 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7857 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7858 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7859 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7860
7861 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7862 instance.
7863
7864 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7865 about ACL usage.
7866
7867
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007868stats realm <realm>
7869 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007871 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007872 Arguments :
7873 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7874 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7875 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7876
7877 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7878 using a backslash ('\').
7879
7880 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7881 only related to authentication.
7882
7883 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7884 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7885 unobvious parameters.
7886
7887 Example :
7888 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7889 backend public_www
7890 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7891 stats enable
7892 stats hide-version
7893 stats scope .
7894 stats uri /admin?stats
7895 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7896 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7897 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7898
7899 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7900 backend private_monitoring
7901 stats enable
7902 stats uri /admin?stats
7903 stats refresh 5s
7904
7905 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7906
7907
7908stats refresh <delay>
7909 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007911 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007912 Arguments :
7913 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7914 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7915 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7916 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7917 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7918 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7919
7920 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7921 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7922 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7923 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7924
7925 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7926 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7927 unobvious parameters.
7928
7929 Example :
7930 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7931 backend public_www
7932 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7933 stats enable
7934 stats hide-version
7935 stats scope .
7936 stats uri /admin?stats
7937 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7938 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7939 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7940
7941 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7942 backend private_monitoring
7943 stats enable
7944 stats uri /admin?stats
7945 stats refresh 5s
7946
7947 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7948
7949
7950stats scope { <name> | "." }
7951 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007953 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007954 Arguments :
7955 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7956 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7957 section in which the statement appears.
7958
7959 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7960 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7961 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
7962 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
7963 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
7964 exists.
7965
7966 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7967 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7968 unobvious parameters.
7969
7970 Example :
7971 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7972 backend public_www
7973 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7974 stats enable
7975 stats hide-version
7976 stats scope .
7977 stats uri /admin?stats
7978 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7979 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7980 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7981
7982 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7983 backend private_monitoring
7984 stats enable
7985 stats uri /admin?stats
7986 stats refresh 5s
7987
7988 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7989
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007990
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007991stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007992 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
7993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007994 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007995
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007996 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007997 description from global section is automatically used instead.
7998
7999 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8000 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8001
8002 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8003 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008004 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008005
8006 Example :
8007 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8008 backend private_monitoring
8009 stats enable
8010 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8011 stats uri /admin?stats
8012 stats refresh 5s
8013
8014 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8015 global section.
8016
8017
8018stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008019 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8021 yes | yes | yes | yes
8022 Arguments : none
8023
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008024 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008025 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8026 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8027 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8028 - IP (socket, server)
8029 - cookie (backend, server)
8030
8031 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8032 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008033 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008034
8035 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8036
8037
8038stats show-node [ <name> ]
8039 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008041 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008042 Arguments:
8043 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8044 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8045
8046 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8047 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008048 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008049
8050 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8051 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8052 unobvious parameters.
8053
8054 Example:
8055 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8056 backend private_monitoring
8057 stats enable
8058 stats show-node Europe-1
8059 stats uri /admin?stats
8060 stats refresh 5s
8061
8062 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8063 section.
8064
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008065
8066stats uri <prefix>
8067 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008069 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008070 Arguments :
8071 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8072 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8073 query string.
8074
8075 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8076 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8077 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8078 possible to reach it in the application.
8079
8080 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008081 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008082 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8083 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8084 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8085 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8086
8087 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8088 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8089 an address or a port to statistics only.
8090
8091 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8092 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8093 unobvious parameters.
8094
8095 Example :
8096 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8097 backend public_www
8098 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8099 stats enable
8100 stats hide-version
8101 stats scope .
8102 stats uri /admin?stats
8103 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8104 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8105 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8106
8107 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8108 backend private_monitoring
8109 stats enable
8110 stats uri /admin?stats
8111 stats refresh 5s
8112
8113 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8114
8115
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008116stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8117 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008119 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008120
8121 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008122 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008123 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8124 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
8125 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8126
8127 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8128 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8129 the "stick-table" statement.
8130
8131 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8132 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8133 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8134 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8135 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8136
8137 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8138 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8139 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8140 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8141 transformation rules.
8142
8143 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8144 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8145 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8146 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8147 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8148 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8149 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8150
8151 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8152 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8153 ACL based conditions.
8154
8155 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8156 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8157 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8158 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8159
8160 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8161 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8162 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8163 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8164
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008165 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8166 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8167 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8168
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008169 Example :
8170 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8171 # last 30 minutes
8172 backend pop
8173 mode tcp
8174 balance roundrobin
8175 stick store-request src
8176 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8177 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8178 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8179
8180 backend smtp
8181 mode tcp
8182 balance roundrobin
8183 stick match src table pop
8184 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8185 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8186
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008187 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008188 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008189
8190
8191stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8192 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8194 no | no | yes | yes
8195
8196 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8197 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8198 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8199 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8200
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008201 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8202 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8203 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8204
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008205 Examples :
8206 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008207 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008208
8209 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8210 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8211 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8212
8213
8214 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8215 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8216 backend http
8217 mode http
8218 balance roundrobin
8219 stick on src table https
8220 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8221 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8222 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8223
8224 backend https
8225 mode tcp
8226 balance roundrobin
8227 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8228 stick on src
8229 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8230 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8231
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008232 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008233
8234
8235stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8236 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8238 no | no | yes | yes
8239
8240 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008241 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008242 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8243 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8244 server is selected.
8245
8246 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8247 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8248 the "stick-table" statement.
8249
8250 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8251 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8252 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8253 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8254 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8255 address.
8256
8257 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8258 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8259 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8260 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8261 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8262 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8263 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8264 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8265 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8266 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8267
8268 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8269 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8270 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8271 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8272 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8273 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8274 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8275
8276 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8277 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8278 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8279 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8280
8281 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8282 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8283 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8284 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8285 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8286 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008287 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8288 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8289 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8290 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8291 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8292 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008293
8294 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8295 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8296 the request.
8297
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008298 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8299 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8300 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8301
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008302 Example :
8303 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8304 # last 30 minutes
8305 backend pop
8306 mode tcp
8307 balance roundrobin
8308 stick store-request src
8309 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8310 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8311 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8312
8313 backend smtp
8314 mode tcp
8315 balance roundrobin
8316 stick match src table pop
8317 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8318 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8319
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008320 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008321 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008322
8323
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008324stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008325 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8326 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008327 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008328 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008329 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008330
8331 Arguments :
8332 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8333 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8334 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8335 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8336
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008337 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8338 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8339 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8340 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8341
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008342 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8343 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8344 instance.
8345
8346 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8347 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8348 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8349 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8350 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8351 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008352 to 32 characters.
8353
8354 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8355 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8356 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008357 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008358 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8359 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008360
8361 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008362 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8363 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008364 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8365 increase.
8366
8367 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008368 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8369 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8370 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008371
8372 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8373 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8374 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8375 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8376 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8377 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8378 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8379 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8380 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8381 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8382 parameter (see below).
8383
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008384 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8385 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8386 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8387 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8388 soft restart.
8389
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008390 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8391 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008392
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008393 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8394 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8395 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8396 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
8397 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008398 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008399 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8400 if not expiration delay is specified.
8401
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008402 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8403 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8404 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8405 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008406 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8407 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8408 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8409 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8410 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8411 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8412 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8413 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8414 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8415 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8416 types and their arguments.
8417
8418 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8419 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8420 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8421 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8422
8423 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8424 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8425 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8426 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8427
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008428 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8429 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8430 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8431 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8432 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8433 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8434
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008435 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8436 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8437 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8438 they were received.
8439
8440 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8441 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8442 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8443 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8444 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8445
8446 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8447 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8448 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8449 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8450 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8451
8452 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8453 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8454 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8455
8456 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8457 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8458 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8459 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8460 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8461
8462 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8463 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8464 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8465 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8466 the client side.
8467
8468 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8469 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8470 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8471 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8472 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8473 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8474 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8475
8476 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8477 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8478 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8479 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8480 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8481 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8482 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8483
8484 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8485 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8486 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8487 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8488 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8489 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8490
8491 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8492 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8493 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8494 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8495
8496 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8497 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8498 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8499 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8500 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8501 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8502 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8503 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8504 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8505 recommended for better fairness.
8506
8507 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8508 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8509 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8510 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8511
8512 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8513 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8514 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8515 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8516 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8517 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8518 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8519 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8520 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8521 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008522
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008523 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8524 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008525 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8526 reference it.
8527
8528 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8529 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008530 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8531 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8532 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008533
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008534 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8535 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8536 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8537 something that can be ignored.
8538
8539 Example:
8540 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8541 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8542 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8543 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8544
8545 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008546 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008547
8548
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008549stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008550 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8552 no | no | yes | yes
8553
8554 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008555 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008556 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8557 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8558 server is selected.
8559
8560 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8561 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8562 the "stick-table" statement.
8563
8564 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8565 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8566 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8567 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8568
8569 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8570 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8571 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8572 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8573 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8574 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008575 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008576 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8577 rules.
8578
8579 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8580 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8581 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8582 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8583 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8584 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8585 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8586
8587 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8588 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8589 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8590 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8591
8592 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8593 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8594 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8595 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8596 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8597 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008598 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8599 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8600 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8601 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8602 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8603 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8604 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8605 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8606 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008607
8608 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8609
8610 Example :
8611 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8612 backend https
8613 mode tcp
8614 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008615 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008616 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008617
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008618 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8619 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8620
8621 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8622 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8623 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8624
8625 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8626 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008627
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008628 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8629 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8630 # at offset 44.
8631
8632 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8633 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8634
8635 # Learn on response if server hello.
8636 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008637
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008638 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8639 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8640
8641 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8642 extraction.
8643
8644
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008645tcp-check connect [params*]
8646 Opens a new connection
8647 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8648 no | no | yes | yes
8649
8650 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8651 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8652 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8653
8654 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8655 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8656 of the sequence.
8657
8658 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8659 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8660 do.
8661
8662 Parameters :
8663 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8664 use the TCP connection.
8665
8666 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8667 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8668 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8669
8670 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8671
8672 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8673
8674 Examples:
8675 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8676 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8677 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8678 option tcp-check
8679 tcp-check connect
8680 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8681 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8682 tcp-check send \r\n
8683 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8684 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8685 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8686 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8687 tcp-check send \r\n
8688 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8689 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8690
8691 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8692 option tcp-check
8693 tcp-check connect port 110
8694 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8695 tcp-check connect port 143
8696 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8697 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8698
8699 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8700
8701
8702tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8703 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8704 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8705 no | no | yes | yes
8706
8707 Arguments :
8708 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8709 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8710 binary.
8711 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8712 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8713 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8714
8715 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8716 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8717 with the usual backslash ('\').
8718 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8719 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8720 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8721 used upper or lower case.
8722
8723
8724 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8725
8726 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8727 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8728 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8729 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8730 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8731 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8732 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8733 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8734
8735 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8736 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8737 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8738 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8739 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8740 expression.
8741
8742 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8743 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8744 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8745 this exact hexadecimal string.
8746 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8747
8748 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8749 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8750 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8751 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8752 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8753 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8754 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8755 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8756 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8757 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8758 the null character.
8759
8760 Examples :
8761 # perform a POP check
8762 option tcp-check
8763 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8764
8765 # perform an IMAP check
8766 option tcp-check
8767 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8768
8769 # look for the redis master server
8770 option tcp-check
8771 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008772 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008773 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8774 tcp-check expect string role:master
8775 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8776 tcp-check expect string +OK
8777
8778
8779 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8780 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8781
8782
8783tcp-check send <data>
8784 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8785 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8786 no | no | yes | yes
8787
8788 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8789 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8790
8791 Examples :
8792 # look for the redis master server
8793 option tcp-check
8794 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8795 tcp-check expect string role:master
8796
8797 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8798 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8799
8800
8801tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8802 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8803 tcp health check
8804 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8805 no | no | yes | yes
8806
8807 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8808 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8809 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8810 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8811 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8812 hexadecimal string.
8813 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8814
8815 Examples :
8816 # redis check in binary
8817 option tcp-check
8818 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8819 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8820
8821
8822 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8823 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8824
8825
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008826tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8827 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8829 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008830 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008831 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8832 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008833
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008834 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008835
8836 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8837 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008838 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8839 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8840 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8841 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8842 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8843 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008844
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008845 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8846 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8847 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8848 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008849
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008850 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008851 - accept :
8852 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8853 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8854 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008855
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008856 - reject :
8857 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8858 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8859 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8860 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8861 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8862 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8863 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8864 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8865 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8866 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8867 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02008868 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008869
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008870 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8871 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8872 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8873 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8874 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8875 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8876 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8877 hosts.
8878
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01008879 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
8880 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
8881 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
8882 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
8883 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
8884 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
8885 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
8886 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
8887
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008888 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8889 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8890 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8891 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8892 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8893 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8894 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8895 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8896 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008897 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8898 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008899
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008900 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008901 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008902 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008903 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008904 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8905 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008906 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008907 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8908 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8909 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8910 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8911 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008912
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008913 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008914 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008915 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008916 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8917 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8918 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8919 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008920
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008921 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8922 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8923 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8924 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008925
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008926 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8927 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8928 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8929 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8930 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008931 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8932 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8933 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8934 layer7 information is extracted.
8935
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008936 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8937 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8938 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8939 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8940 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008941
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008942 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
8943 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
8944 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
8945 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
8946
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008947 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
8948 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
8949 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
8950 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
8951 continues.
8952
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02008953 - set-src <expr> :
8954 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
8955 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
8956 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
8957 set-src"
8958
8959 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8960 followed by some converters.
8961
8962 Example:
8963
8964 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
8965
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008966 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
8967 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02008968
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02008969 - set-src-port <expr> :
8970 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
8971 expression.
8972
8973 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8974 followed by some converters.
8975
8976 Example:
8977
8978 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
8979
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008980 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
8981 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
8982 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02008983
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02008984 - set-dst <expr> :
8985 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
8986 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
8987 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
8988 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
8989 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
8990
8991 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8992 followed by some converters.
8993
8994 Example:
8995
8996 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
8997 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
8998
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008999 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9000 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9001
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009002 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9003 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9004 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9005 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9006
9007
9008 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9009 followed by some converters.
9010
9011 Example:
9012
9013 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9014
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009015 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9016 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9017 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9018
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009019 - "silent-drop" :
9020 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9021 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9022 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9023 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9024 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9025 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9026 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9027 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9028 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9029 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9030 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9031 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9032 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9033 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9034 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9035 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9036
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009037 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9038 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9039 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009040
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009041 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9042 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9043 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009044
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009045 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009046 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009047 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009048
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009049 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9050 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9051 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009052
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009053 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009054 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9055 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009056
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009057 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9058
9059 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9060
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009061 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9062
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009063 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009064
9065
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009066tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9067 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009069 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009070 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009071 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9072 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009073
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009074 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009075
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009076 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
9077 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9078 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9079 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9080 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009081
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009082 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9083 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9084 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9085 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009086 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9087 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9088 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9089 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9090 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9091 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009092 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009093 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009094
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009095 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9096 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9097 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9098 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009099
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009100 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009101 - accept : the request is accepted
9102 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9103 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009104 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009105 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009106 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009107 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009108 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009109 - silent-drop
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009110
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009111 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9112 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009113
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009114 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9115 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9116 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9117 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9118 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9119 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009120
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009121 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009122 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9123 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009124
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009125 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009126 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9127 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9128 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9129 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009130 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9131 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9132 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009133
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009134 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009135 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9136 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9137 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009138
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009139 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009140 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9141 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009142
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009143 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9144 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009145 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009146 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9147 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009148 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009149 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009150 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009151 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9152 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009153 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009154 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9155 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009156
9157 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9158 followed by some converters.
9159
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009160 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9161 <var-name>.
9162
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009163 Example:
9164
9165 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009166 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009167
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009168 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009169 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9170 # and reject everything else.
9171 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9172 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009173 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009174 tcp-request content reject
9175
9176 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009177 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9178 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9179 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009180 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009181
9182 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9183 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9184 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009185 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009186 tcp-request content reject
9187
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009188 Example:
9189 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
9190 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009191 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009192
9193 Example:
9194 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9195 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009196 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009197
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009198 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
9199 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
9200
9201 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009202 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009203 # protecting all our sites
9204 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009205 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9206 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009207 ...
9208 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9209
9210 backend http_dynamic
9211 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009212 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009213 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009214 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
9215 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
9216 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009217 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009218
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009219 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009220
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009221 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session", and
9222 "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009223
9224
9225tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9226 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009228 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009229 Arguments :
9230 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9231 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9232 as explained at the top of this document.
9233
9234 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9235 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9236 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9237 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9238 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9239
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009240 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9241 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9242 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9243 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9244
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009245 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9246 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009247 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009248 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009249 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9250 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9251 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9252 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009253
9254 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9255 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9256 it pass through unaffected.
9257
9258 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9259 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9260 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009261 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009262 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9263 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009264 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9265 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9266 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009267
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009268 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009269 "timeout client".
9270
9271
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009272tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9273 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9275 no | no | yes | yes
9276 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009277 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9278 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009279
9280 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9281
9282 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
9283 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9284 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009285 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9286 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009287
9288 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9289
9290 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9291 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9292 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9293 inserted.
9294
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009295 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009296 - accept :
9297 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9298 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9299 the rules evaluation.
9300
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009301 - close :
9302 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9303 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9304 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9305 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9306 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9307 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009308 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009309 protocols.
9310
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009311 - reject :
9312 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9313 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009314 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009315
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009316 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9317 Sets a variable.
9318
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009319 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9320 Unsets a variable.
9321
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009322 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9323 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9324 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9325 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9326
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009327 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9328 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9329 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9330 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9331 continues.
9332
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009333 - "silent-drop" :
9334 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9335 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9336 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9337 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9338 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9339 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9340 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9341 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9342 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9343 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9344 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9345 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9346 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9347 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9348 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9349 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9350
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009351 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9352 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9353 for changing the default action to a reject.
9354
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009355 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9356 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9357 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9358 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009359 period.
9360
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009361 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9362 declared inline.
9363
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009364 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9365 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009366 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009367 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9368 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009369 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009370 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009371 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009372 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9373 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009374 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009375 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9376 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009377
9378 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9379 followed by some converters.
9380
9381 Example:
9382
9383 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9384
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009385 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9386 <var-name>.
9387
9388 Example:
9389
9390 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9391
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009392 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9393
9394 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9395
9396
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009397tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9398 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9400 no | yes | yes | no
9401 Arguments :
9402 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9403 below.
9404
9405 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9406
9407 Once a session is validated, (ie. after all handshakes have been completed),
9408 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9409 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9410 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9411 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9412 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9413 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9414 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
9415 from the PROXY protocol header (eg: track a source forwarded this way). The
9416 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9417 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9418 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9419 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9420 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9421 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9422 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9423 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9424 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9425 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9426 instead.
9427
9428 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9429 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9430 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9431 rules which may be inserted.
9432
9433 Several types of actions are supported :
9434 - accept : the request is accepted
9435 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9436 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9437 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
9438 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9439 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009440 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009441 - silent-drop
9442
9443 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9444 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9445 sections for a complete description.
9446
9447 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9448 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9449 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9450
9451 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9452 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9453 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9454 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9455 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9456
9457 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9458 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9459
9460 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9461 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9462 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9463
9464 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9465 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9466 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9467
9468 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9469 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9470 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9471
9472 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9473 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9474 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9475
9476 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9477
9478 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9479
9480
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009481tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9482 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9484 no | no | yes | yes
9485 Arguments :
9486 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9487 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9488 as explained at the top of this document.
9489
9490 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9491
9492
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009493timeout check <timeout>
9494 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9495 established.
9496
9497 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9498 yes | no | yes | yes
9499 Arguments:
9500 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9501 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9502 as explained at the top of this document.
9503
9504 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9505 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9506 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9507 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009508 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9509 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9510 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009511
9512 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9513 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9514
9515 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9516 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009517 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009518
9519 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9520 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9521 forget about it.
9522
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009523 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9524 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009525
9526
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009527timeout client <timeout>
9528timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9529 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9531 yes | yes | yes | no
9532 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009533 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009534 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9535 as explained at the top of this document.
9536
9537 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9538 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9539 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009540 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9541 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9542 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9543 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009544 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9545 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9546 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009547 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009548 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009549 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9550 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009551 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9552 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009553
9554 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9555 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9556 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9557 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9558 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9559 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9560
9561 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9562 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9563 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9564
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009565 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9566 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009567
9568
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009569timeout client-fin <timeout>
9570 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9572 yes | yes | yes | no
9573 Arguments :
9574 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9575 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9576 as explained at the top of this document.
9577
9578 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9579 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9580 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9581 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9582 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9583 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9584 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9585 down in one direction.
9586
9587 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9588 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9589 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9590
9591 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9592
9593
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009594timeout connect <timeout>
9595timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9596 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9598 yes | no | yes | yes
9599 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009600 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009601 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9602 as explained at the top of this document.
9603
9604 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009605 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009606 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009607 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009608 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9609 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009610
9611 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9612 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9613 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9614 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9615 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9616 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9617
9618 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9619 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9620 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9621
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009622 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9623 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009624
9625
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009626timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9627 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9629 yes | yes | yes | yes
9630 Arguments :
9631 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9632 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9633 as explained at the top of this document.
9634
9635 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9636 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9637 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9638 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9639 once the request has started to present itself.
9640
9641 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9642 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9643 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9644 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9645 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9646
9647 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9648 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9649 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9650 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9651
9652 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9653 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9654 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9655 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9656 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009657 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009658
9659 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9660 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9661 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9662 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9663
9664 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9665
9666
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009667timeout http-request <timeout>
9668 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009670 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009671 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009672 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009673 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9674 as explained at the top of this document.
9675
9676 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9677 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9678 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9679 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9680 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9681 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9682 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009683 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9684 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9685 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9686 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9687 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009688 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9689 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009690
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009691 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9692 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9693 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9694 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9695 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009696 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009697
9698 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9699 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9700 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9701 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9702 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9703
9704 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009705 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9706 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9707 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009708
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009709 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009710 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009711
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009712
9713timeout queue <timeout>
9714 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9716 yes | no | yes | yes
9717 Arguments :
9718 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9719 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9720 as explained at the top of this document.
9721
9722 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9723 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9724 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9725 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9726 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9727
9728 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9729 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9730 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9731 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9732
9733 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9734
9735
9736timeout server <timeout>
9737timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9738 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9740 yes | no | yes | yes
9741 Arguments :
9742 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9743 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9744 as explained at the top of this document.
9745
9746 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9747 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9748 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9749 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9750 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9751 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9752 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9753
9754 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9755 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9756 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9757 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9758 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009759 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009760 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009761 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9762 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9763 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9764 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009765
9766 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9767 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9768 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9769 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9770 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9771 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9772
9773 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
9774 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
9775 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9776
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009777 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009778
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009779
9780timeout server-fin <timeout>
9781 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
9782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9783 yes | no | yes | yes
9784 Arguments :
9785 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9786 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9787 as explained at the top of this document.
9788
9789 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9790 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9791 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9792 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9793 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
9794 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9795 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9796 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
9797 situations, it should not be needed.
9798
9799 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9800 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9801 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
9802
9803 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
9804
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009805
9806timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009807 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9809 yes | yes | yes | yes
9810 Arguments :
9811 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
9812 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9813 as explained at the top of this document.
9814
9815 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
9816 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
9817 defines how long it will be maintained open.
9818
9819 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9820 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9821 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
9822 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009823 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009824
9825 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9826
9827
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009828timeout tunnel <timeout>
9829 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
9830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9831 yes | no | yes | yes
9832 Arguments :
9833 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9834 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9835 as explained at the top of this document.
9836
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009837 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009838 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
9839 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
9840 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
9841 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
9842 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
9843 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
9844 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
9845 specified.
9846
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009847 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
9848 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
9849 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
9850 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
9851 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
9852 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
9853 state.
9854
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009855 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9856 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9857 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
9858 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
9859 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
9860
9861 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9862 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9863 forget about it.
9864
9865 Example :
9866 defaults http
9867 option http-server-close
9868 timeout connect 5s
9869 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009870 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009871 timeout server 30s
9872 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
9873
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009874 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009875
9876
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009877transparent (deprecated)
9878 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009880 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009881 Arguments : none
9882
9883 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
9884 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9885 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9886 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9887 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9888 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9889 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9890 appropriate server.
9891
9892 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
9893
9894 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9895 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9896
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009897 See also: "option transparent"
9898
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009899unique-id-format <string>
9900 Generate a unique ID for each request.
9901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9902 yes | yes | yes | no
9903 Arguments :
9904 <string> is a log-format string.
9905
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009906 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
9907 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
9908 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
9909 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009910
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009911 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
9912 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
9913 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
9914 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
9915 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
9916 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
9917 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
9918 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009919
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009920 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
9921 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009922
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009923 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009924
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009925 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009926
9927 will generate:
9928
9929 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9930
9931 See also: "unique-id-header"
9932
9933unique-id-header <name>
9934 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
9935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9936 yes | yes | yes | no
9937 Arguments :
9938 <name> is the name of the header.
9939
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009940 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
9941 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009942
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009943 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009944
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009945 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009946 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
9947
9948 will generate:
9949
9950 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9951
9952 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009953
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009954use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009955 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009956 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9957 no | yes | yes | no
9958 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009959 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
9960 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009961
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009962 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
9963 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009964
9965 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
9966 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
9967 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009968 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
9969 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
9970 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
9971 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009972
9973 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
9974 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
9975 assign the backend.
9976
9977 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
9978 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9979 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
9980 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
9981 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
9982 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
9983
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009984 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009985 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009986 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
9987 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
9988 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
9989
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009990 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
9991 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
9992 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
9993 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
9994 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
9995 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
9996 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
9997 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
9998 cannot be forced from the request.
9999
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010000 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010001 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10002 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10003
10004 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10005 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010006
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010007
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010008use-server <server> if <condition>
10009use-server <server> unless <condition>
10010 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10012 no | no | yes | yes
10013 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010014 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010015
10016 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10017
10018 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10019 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10020 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10021
10022 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10023 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10024 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10025 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10026 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10027 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10028 matches will assign the server.
10029
10030 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10031 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10032 with the next rules until one matches.
10033
10034 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10035 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10036 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10037 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10038
10039 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10040 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10041 stripped.
10042
10043 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10044 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10045 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10046 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10047
10048 Example :
10049 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10050 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10051 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10052 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10053 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10054 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
10055 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
10056 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10057 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10058
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010059 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010060
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010061
100625. Bind and Server options
10063--------------------------
10064
10065The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10066depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10067settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10068written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10069described in this section.
10070
10071
100725.1. Bind options
10073-----------------
10074
10075The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10076as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10077no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10078parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10079while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10080provided immediately after the setting name.
10081
10082The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10083
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010084accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10085 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10086 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10087 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10088 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10089 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10090 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10091 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10092 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10093 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010094 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10095 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10096 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010097
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010098accept-proxy
10099 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010100 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10101 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010102 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10103 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10104 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10105 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
10106 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
10107 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10108 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010109 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10110 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010111
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010112alpn <protocols>
10113 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10114 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10115 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10116 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10117 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
10118 initial NPN extension.
10119
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010120backlog <backlog>
10121 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10122 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10123
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010124curves <curves>
10125 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10126 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10127 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10128 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10129 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10130 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10131
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010132ecdhe <named curve>
10133 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010134 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10135 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010136
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010137ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010138 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10139 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10140 client's certificate.
10141
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010142ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10143 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10144 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10145 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10146 error is ignored.
10147
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010148ca-sign-file <cafile>
10149 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10150 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10151 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10152 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10153 'generate-certificates' for details.
10154
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010155ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010156 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10157 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10158 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10159 'generate-certificates' for details.
10160
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010161ciphers <ciphers>
10162 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10163 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010164 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010165 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
10166 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
10167
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010168crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010169 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10170 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10171 to verify client's certificate.
10172
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010173crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010174 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10175 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10176 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10177 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10178 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10179 file.
10180
10181 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10182 are loaded.
10183
10184 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010185 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010186 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10187 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10188 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10189 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
10190 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10191 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
10192 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010193
10194 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10195 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10196 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10197 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010198 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10199 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010200
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010201 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010202
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010203 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
10204 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +080010205 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010206 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
10207 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10208 clients).
10209
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010210 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10211 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10212 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10213 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10214 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10215 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10216 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10217 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10218 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10219 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10220 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10221 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10222 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10223
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010224 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10225 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10226 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10227 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10228 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10229
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010230 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10231 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10232 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10233 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010234
10235 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10236 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10237 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10238 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10239 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10240 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10241 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10242 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10243 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10244
10245 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10246
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010247 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010248 a cert bundle.
10249
10250 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
10251 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10252 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10253 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10254 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10255 provide multi-cert support.
10256
10257 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10258
10259 Filename | CN | SAN
10260 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10261 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010262 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010263 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10264 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10265
10266 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10267 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10268 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10269 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010270 suites. With BoringSSL multi-cert is natively supported, no need to bundle
10271 certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010272
10273 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10274 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10275
10276 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10277 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10278 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10279
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010280crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010281 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
10282 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010283 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010284 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010285
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010286crt-list <file>
10287 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010288 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10289 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010290
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010291 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10292
10293 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca_file", "crl_file", "ecdhe",
Emmanuel Hocdet4608ed92017-01-20 13:06:27 +010010294 "curves", "ciphers" configuration.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010295 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010296
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010297 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10298 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10299 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10300 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10301 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10302 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10303 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10304 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010305
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010306 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010307 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010308 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL multi-cert is natively supported,
10309 avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can be declared in a
10310 row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010311
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010312 crt-list file example:
10313 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010314 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010315 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010316 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010317
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010318defer-accept
10319 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10320 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10321 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
10322 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
10323 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10324 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10325 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10326 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10327 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10328 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10329 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10330
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010331force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010332 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010333 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010334 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10335 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010336
10337force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010338 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010339 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10340 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010341
10342force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010343 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010344 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10345 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010346
10347force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010348 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010349 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10350 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010351
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010352generate-certificates
10353 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10354 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10355 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10356 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10357 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10358 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10359 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10360 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10361 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10362 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10363 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10364
10365 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10366 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
10367 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
10368 certificate is used many times.
10369
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010370gid <gid>
10371 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10372 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10373 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10374 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10375 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10376
10377group <group>
10378 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10379 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10380 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10381 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10382 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10383
10384id <id>
10385 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10386 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10387 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10388 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10389
10390interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010391 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10392 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10393 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10394 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10395 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10396 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
10397 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010398
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010399level <level>
10400 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10401 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10402 sockets. <level> can be one of :
10403 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
10404 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10405 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10406 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
10407 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
10408 counters).
10409 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
10410 all counters).
10411
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010412maxconn <maxconn>
10413 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10414 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10415 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10416 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10417 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10418 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10419 eat all memory.
10420
10421mode <mode>
10422 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10423 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10424 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10425 UNIX sockets.
10426
10427mss <maxseg>
10428 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10429 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10430 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10431 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10432 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10433 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10434 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10435 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10436 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10437 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10438 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10439
10440name <name>
10441 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10442 page.
10443
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010444namespace <name>
10445 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10446 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10447 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10448 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10449
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010450nice <nice>
10451 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10452 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10453 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10454 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10455 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10456 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10457 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10458 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10459 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10460 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10461 one for an RDP socket.
10462
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010463no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010464 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010465 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010466 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010467 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
10468 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010469 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010470
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010471no-tls-tickets
10472 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10473 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10474 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010475 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10476 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010477
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010478no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010479 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010480 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010481 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010482 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10483 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10484 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010485
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010486no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010487 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010488 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010489 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010490 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10491 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10492 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010493
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010494no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010495 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010496 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010497 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010498 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10499 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10500 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010501
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010502npn <protocols>
10503 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10504 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10505 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10506 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010507 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
10508 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010509
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010510process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
10511 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
10512 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
10513 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
10514 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
10515 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
10516 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
10517 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +020010518 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
10519 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
10520 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
10521 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
10522 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
10523 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
10524 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010525
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010526ssl
10527 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010528 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010529 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10530 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
10531 to deciphered contents.
10532
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010533strict-sni
10534 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10535 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10536 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10537 See the "crt" option for more information.
10538
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010539tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010540 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010541 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10542 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010543 receiving an acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010544 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10545 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10546 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10547 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10548 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10549 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10550 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10551
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010552tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010553 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010554 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10555 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10556 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10557 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10558 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10559 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10560 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010561 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10562 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10563 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010564
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010565tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10566 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10567 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10568 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10569 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10570 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10571 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10572 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10573 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10574 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10575 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10576
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010577transparent
10578 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10579 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10580 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10581 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10582 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10583 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10584 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10585 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10586 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10587 so check for support with your vendor.
10588
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010589v4v6
10590 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10591 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10592 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10593 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010594 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010595
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010596v6only
10597 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10598 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10599 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010600 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10601 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010602
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010603uid <uid>
10604 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10605 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10606 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10607 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10608 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10609
10610user <user>
10611 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10612 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10613 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10614 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10615 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10616
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010617verify [none|optional|required]
10618 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10619 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10620 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10621 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10622 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010623 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10624 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10625 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10626 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010627
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200106285.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010629------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010630
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010631The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
10632which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
10633arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
10634settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
10635after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
10636Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
10637address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010638
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010639 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010640 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010641
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010642The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010643
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010644addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010645 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010010646 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
10647 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
10648 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
10649 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
10650 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010651
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010652 Supported in default-server: No
10653
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010654agent-check
10655 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010656 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10657 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10658 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10659 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010660
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010661 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010662 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010663 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10664 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10665 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010666
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020010667 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values in
10668 this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
10669 connections advertised needs to be multipled by the number of load balancers
10670 and different backends that use this health check to get the total number
10671 of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
10672
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010673 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10674 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010675
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010676 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10677 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10678 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010679
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010680 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10681 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10682 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010683
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010684 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10685 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10686 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10687 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10688 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10689 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10690 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010691
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010692 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10693 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010694
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010695 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10696 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
10697 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
10698 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
10699 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
10700 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
10701 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
10702 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
10703 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010704
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010705 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
10706 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010707 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
10708 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
10709 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010010710 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010711
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010712 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
10713 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010714
10715 Supported in default-server: No
10716
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070010717agent-send <string>
10718 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
10719 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
10720 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
10721 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
10722 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
10723
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010724agent-inter <delay>
10725 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
10726 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10727
10728 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
10729 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
10730 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
10731 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
10732 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10733 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10734 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10735 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10736 of backends use the same servers.
10737
10738 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
10739
10740 Supported in default-server: Yes
10741
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010010742agent-addr <addr>
10743 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
10744
10745 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
10746 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
10747 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
10748 hostname, it will be resolved.
10749
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010750agent-port <port>
10751 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
10752
10753 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
10754
10755 Supported in default-server: Yes
10756
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010757backup
10758 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
10759 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
10760 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
10761 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
10762 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
10763 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010764
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010765 Supported in default-server: No
10766
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010767ca-file <cafile>
10768 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10769 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10770 server's certificate.
10771
10772 Supported in default-server: No
10773
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010774check
10775 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010010776 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
10777 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
10778 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
10779 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
10780 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
10781 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
10782 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010783 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
10784 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
10785 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010786
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010787 Supported in default-server: No
10788
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010789check-send-proxy
10790 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
10791 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
10792 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
10793 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
10794 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
10795 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
10796 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
10797
10798 Supported in default-server: No
10799
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010800check-ssl
10801 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
10802 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
10803 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
10804 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010805 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010806 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
10807 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
10808 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
10809 See the "ssl" option for more information.
10810
10811 Supported in default-server: No
10812
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010813ciphers <ciphers>
10814 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010815 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010816 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
10817 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
10818 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
10819 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
10820 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
10821 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
10822
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010823 Supported in default-server: No
10824
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010825cookie <value>
10826 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
10827 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
10828 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
10829 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
10830 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
10831 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
10832 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
10833
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010834 Supported in default-server: No
10835
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010836crl-file <crlfile>
10837 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10838 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10839 to verify server's certificate.
10840
10841 Supported in default-server: No
10842
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020010843crt <cert>
10844 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10845 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
10846 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
10847 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
10848 certificate request.
10849
10850 Supported in default-server: No
10851
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010852disabled
10853 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
10854 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
10855 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
10856 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
10857 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
10858
10859 Supported in default-server: No
10860
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010861error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010862 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
10863 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
10864 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010865
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010866 Supported in default-server: Yes
10867
10868 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010869
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010870fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010871 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
10872 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
10873 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
10874
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010875 Supported in default-server: Yes
10876
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010877force-sslv3
10878 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
10879 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010880 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10881 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010882
10883 Supported in default-server: No
10884
10885force-tlsv10
10886 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010887 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10888 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010889
10890 Supported in default-server: No
10891
10892force-tlsv11
10893 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010894 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10895 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010896
10897 Supported in default-server: No
10898
10899force-tlsv12
10900 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010901 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10902 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010903
10904 Supported in default-server: No
10905
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010906id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020010907 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
10908 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
10909 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010910
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010911 Supported in default-server: No
10912
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010913init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
10914 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
10915 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
10916 turn each of the methods mentionned in the comma-delimited list. The first
10917 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
10918 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
10919 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
10920 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
10921 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
10922 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
10923 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
10924 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
10925 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
10926 server (eg: filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
10927 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
10928 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
10929 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
10930 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
10931 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
10932 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
10933 historic behaviour.
10934
10935 Example:
10936 defaults
10937 # never fail on address resolution
10938 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
10939
10940 Supported in default-server: Yes
10941
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010942inter <delay>
10943fastinter <delay>
10944downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010945 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
10946 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10947 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
10948 between checks depending on the server state :
10949
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020010950 Server state | Interval used
10951 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10952 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
10953 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10954 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
10955 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
10956 or yet unchecked. |
10957 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10958 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
10959 | "inter" otherwise.
10960 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010961
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010962 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
10963 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
10964 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
10965 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010966 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10967 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10968 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10969 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10970 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010971
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010972 Supported in default-server: Yes
10973
10974maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010975 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
10976 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
10977 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
10978 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
10979 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
10980 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
10981 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
10982 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
10983
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010984 Supported in default-server: Yes
10985
10986maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010987 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
10988 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
10989 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
10990 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
10991 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
10992 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
10993 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
10994
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010995 Supported in default-server: Yes
10996
10997minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010998 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
10999 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11000 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11001 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11002 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11003 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011004 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011005 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011006
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011007 Supported in default-server: Yes
11008
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011009namespace <name>
11010 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11011 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11012 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11013 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11014
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011015no-ssl-reuse
11016 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11017 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11018 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11019 and for paranoid users.
11020
11021 Supported in default-server: No
11022
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011023no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011024 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11025 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011026 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011027
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011028 Supported in default-server: No
11029
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011030no-tls-tickets
11031 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11032 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11033 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011034 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11035 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011036
11037 Supported in default-server: No
11038
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011039no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011040 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011041 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11042 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011043 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11044 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
11045 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011046
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011047 Supported in default-server: No
11048
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011049no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011050 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011051 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11052 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011053 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11054 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
11055 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011056
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011057 Supported in default-server: No
11058
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011059no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011060 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011061 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11062 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011063 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11064 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
11065 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011066
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011067 Supported in default-server: No
11068
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011069non-stick
11070 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11071 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11072 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11073
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011074 Supported in default-server: No
11075
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011076observe <mode>
11077 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11078 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11079 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11080 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11081 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11082 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011083 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011084
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011085 Supported in default-server: No
11086
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011087 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11088
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011089on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011090 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11091 Currently, four modes are available:
11092 - fastinter: force fastinter
11093 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11094 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11095 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11096 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11097
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011098 Supported in default-server: Yes
11099
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011100 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11101
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011102on-marked-down <action>
11103 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11104 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011105 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11106 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11107 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11108 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11109 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11110 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11111 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11112 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011113
11114 Actions are disabled by default
11115
11116 Supported in default-server: Yes
11117
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011118on-marked-up <action>
11119 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11120 Currently one action is available:
11121 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11122 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11123 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11124 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
11125 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11126 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
11127 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11128 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11129
11130 Actions are disabled by default
11131
11132 Supported in default-server: Yes
11133
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011134port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011135 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11136 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11137 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11138 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11139 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11140 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11141
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011142 Supported in default-server: Yes
11143
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011144redir <prefix>
11145 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11146 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11147 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11148 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11149 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11150 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11151 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11152 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011153 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011154 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
11155 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11156 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11157 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11158 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11159
11160 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11161
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011162 Supported in default-server: No
11163
11164rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011165 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11166 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11167 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11168
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011169 Supported in default-server: Yes
11170
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011171resolve-prefer <family>
11172 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11173 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11174 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11175 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11176
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011177 Default value: ipv6
11178
11179 Supported in default-server: Yes
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011180
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011181 Example:
11182
11183 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011184
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011185resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
11186 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
11187 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011188 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011189 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11190 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
11191 configured network, another address is selected.
11192
11193 Supported in default-server: Yes
11194
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011195 Example:
11196
11197 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011198
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011199resolvers <id>
11200 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11201 hostname.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011202 In order to be operational, DNS resolution requires that health check is
11203 enabled on the server. Actually, health checks triggers the DNS resolution.
11204 You must precise one 'resolvers' parameter on each server line where DNS
11205 resolution is required.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011206
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011207 Supported in default-server: No
11208
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011209 Example:
11210
11211 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011212
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011213 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011214
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011215send-proxy
11216 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11217 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11218 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11219 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011220 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11221 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11222 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11223 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11224 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11225 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11226 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11227 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11228 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11229 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
11230 See also the "accept-proxy" and "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind"
11231 keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011232
11233 Supported in default-server: No
11234
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011235send-proxy-v2
11236 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11237 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11238 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11239 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11240 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
11241 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
11242 option of the "bind" keyword.
11243
11244 Supported in default-server: No
11245
11246send-proxy-v2-ssl
11247 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11248 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11249 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11250 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11251 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11252 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
11253 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
11254 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
11255
11256 Supported in default-server: No
11257
11258send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11259 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11260 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11261 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11262 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11263 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11264 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
11265 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
11266 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
11267 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
11268
11269 Supported in default-server: No
11270
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011271slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011272 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
11273 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
11274 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
11275 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
11276 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
11277 parameters :
11278
11279 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
11280 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
11281
11282 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
11283 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
11284 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
11285 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
11286
11287 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
11288 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
11289 seen as failed.
11290
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011291 Supported in default-server: Yes
11292
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011293sni <expression>
11294 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
11295 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
11296 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
11297 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
11298 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense.
11299
11300 Supported in default-server: no
11301
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011302source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011303source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011304source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011305 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
11306 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
11307 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
11308 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
11309
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011310 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
11311 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
11312 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
11313 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
11314 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
11315 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
11316 server.
11317
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000011318 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
11319 specifying the source address without port(s).
11320
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011321 Supported in default-server: No
11322
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011323ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011324 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
11325 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
11326 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
11327 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
11328 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
11329 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011330 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011331
11332 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011333
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011334tcp-ut <delay>
11335 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
11336 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
11337 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011338 acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011339 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
11340 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
11341 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
11342 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
11343 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
11344 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
11345 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
11346 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
11347 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11348
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011349track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020011350 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
11351 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
11352 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
11353 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011354 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
11355
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011356 Supported in default-server: No
11357
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011358verify [none|required]
11359 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010011360 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
11361 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
11362 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
11363 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011364 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
11365 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
11366 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011367
11368 Supported in default-server: No
11369
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011370verifyhost <hostname>
11371 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
11372 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
11373 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
11374 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
11375 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
11376 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
11377
11378 Supported in default-server: No
11379
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011380weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011381 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
11382 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
11383 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020011384 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
11385 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
11386 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
11387 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
11388 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
11389 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011390
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011391 Supported in default-server: Yes
11392
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011393
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200113945.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
11395-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011396
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011397HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
11398using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
11399configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011400This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
11401can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
11402workload.
11403This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11404resolution at run time.
11405Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11406carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11407
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011408Bear in mind that DNS resolution is triggered by health checks. This makes
11409health checks mandatory to allow DNS resolution.
11410
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011411
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200114125.3.1. Global overview
11413----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011414
11415As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11416different steps of the process life:
11417
11418 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11419 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11420 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11421
11422 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
11423 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
11424 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
11425
11426A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11427 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11428 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11429 resolution to know this new IP.
11430
11431A few things important to notice:
11432 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11433 first valid response.
11434
11435 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11436 servers return an error.
11437
11438
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200114395.3.2. The resolvers section
11440----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011441
11442This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
11443HAProxy.
11444There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
11445many name servers.
11446
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011447When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11448uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11449is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11450answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11451
11452When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
11453used by HAProxy to decide what type of behavior to apply.
11454
11455Two types of behavior can be applied:
11456 1. stop DNS resolution
11457 2. replay the DNS query with a new query type
11458 In such case, the following types are applied in this exact order:
11459 1. ANY query type
11460 2. query type corresponding to family pointed by resolve-prefer
11461 server's parameter
11462 3. remaining family type
11463
11464HAProxy stops DNS resolution when the following errors occur:
11465 - invalid DNS response packet
11466 - wrong name in the query section of the response
11467 - NX domain
11468 - Query refused by server
11469 - CNAME not pointing to an IP address
11470
11471HAProxy tries a new query type when the following errors occur:
11472 - no Answer records in the response
11473 - DNS response truncated
11474 - Error in DNS response
11475 - No expected DNS records found in the response
11476 - name server timeout
11477
11478For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section:
11479 - first response is valid and is applied directly, second response is ignored
11480 - first response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
11481 applied;
11482 - first response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
11483 HAProxy replays the query with a new type;
11484 - first response is truncated and second one is a NX Domain, then HAProxy
11485 stops resolution.
11486
11487
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011488resolvers <resolvers id>
11489 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
11490
11491A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
11492
11493nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
11494 DNS server description:
11495 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
11496 <ip> : IP address of the server
11497 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
11498
11499hold <status> <period>
11500 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
11501 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011502 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
11503 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011504 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
11505 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11506 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
11507
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011508 Default value is 10s for "valid" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011509
11510 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
11511 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
11512 the healch check.
11513
11514resolve_retries <nb>
11515 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
11516 giving up.
11517 Default value: 3
11518
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011519 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
11520 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
11521 type.
11522
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011523timeout <event> <time>
11524 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
11525 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
11526 events available are:
11527 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
11528 been received.
11529 Default value: 1s
11530 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11531 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
11532
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011533 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011534
11535 resolvers mydns
11536 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
11537 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
11538 resolve_retries 3
11539 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011540 hold other 30s
11541 hold refused 30s
11542 hold nx 30s
11543 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011544 hold valid 10s
11545
11546
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115476. HTTP header manipulation
11548---------------------------
11549
11550In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
11551response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
11552request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
11553which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011554against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011555
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011556If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
11557to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
11558but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
11559HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
11560stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
11561because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
11562a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
11563still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020011564
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011565This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
11566in section 4.2 :
11567
11568 - reqadd <string>
11569 - reqallow <search>
11570 - reqiallow <search>
11571 - reqdel <search>
11572 - reqidel <search>
11573 - reqdeny <search>
11574 - reqideny <search>
11575 - reqpass <search>
11576 - reqipass <search>
11577 - reqrep <search> <replace>
11578 - reqirep <search> <replace>
11579 - reqtarpit <search>
11580 - reqitarpit <search>
11581 - rspadd <string>
11582 - rspdel <search>
11583 - rspidel <search>
11584 - rspdeny <search>
11585 - rspideny <search>
11586 - rsprep <search> <replace>
11587 - rspirep <search> <replace>
11588
11589With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
11590is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
11591parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
11592prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
11593Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
11594
11595 \t for a tab
11596 \r for a carriage return (CR)
11597 \n for a new line (LF)
11598 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
11599 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
11600 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
11601 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
11602 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
11603
11604The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
11605portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
11606above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
11607regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
116089 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
11609is very common to users of the "sed" program.
11610
11611The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
11612after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
11613
11614Notes related to these keywords :
11615---------------------------------
11616 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
11617 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
11618 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
11619
11620 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
11621 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
11622 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
11623
11624 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
11625 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
11626 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
11627 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
11628 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
11629
11630 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
11631 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
11632 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
11633 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
11634 useless headers before adding new ones.
11635
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011636 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011637 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
11638
11639 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
11640 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
11641 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
11642
11643 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
11644 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011645 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011646
11647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200116487. Using ACLs and fetching samples
11649----------------------------------
11650
11651Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
11652client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
11653The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
11654these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
11655but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
11656data called patterns.
11657
11658
116597.1. ACL basics
11660---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011661
11662The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
11663content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
11664from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
11665simple :
11666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011667 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011668 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011669 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
11670 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011672The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
11673adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011674
11675In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
11676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011677 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011678
11679This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
11680Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
11681and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011682an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
11683conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
11684as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
11685are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011686
11687ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
11688'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
11689which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
11690
11691There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
11692performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
11693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011694The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
11695specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
11696this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011697methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
11698ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011699
11700Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
11701 - boolean
11702 - integer (signed or unsigned)
11703 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
11704 - string
11705 - data block
11706
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011707Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
11708converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
11709would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
11710The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
11711which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
11712
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011713Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
11714keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
11715fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
11716which are summarized in the table below :
11717
11718 +---------------------+-----------------+
11719 | Sample or converter | Default |
11720 | output type | matching method |
11721 +---------------------+-----------------+
11722 | boolean | bool |
11723 +---------------------+-----------------+
11724 | integer | int |
11725 +---------------------+-----------------+
11726 | ip | ip |
11727 +---------------------+-----------------+
11728 | string | str |
11729 +---------------------+-----------------+
11730 | binary | none, use "-m" |
11731 +---------------------+-----------------+
11732
11733Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
11734matching method, see below.
11735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011736The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
11737 - boolean
11738 - integer or integer range
11739 - IP address / network
11740 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
11741 - regular expression
11742 - hex block
11743
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011744The following ACL flags are currently supported :
11745
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011746 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
11747 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011748 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011749 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011750 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011751 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011752 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
11753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011754The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
11755read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
11756if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
11757lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
11758will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
11759beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
11760a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
11761lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
11762exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
11763
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011764The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
11765parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
11766ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
11767a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
11768check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
11769
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011770The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
11771socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
11772file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
11773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011774Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
11775loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
11776
11777 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
11778
11779In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
11780the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
11781case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
11782as well.
11783
11784The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
11785sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
11786do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
11787methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
11788is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
11789obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
11790followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
11791default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
11792that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
11793string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
11794
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011795The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
11796By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
11797string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
11798resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
11799server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
11800waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
11801flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
11802function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
11803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011804There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
11805sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
11806be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011807
11808 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
11809 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011810 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
11811 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
11812 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
11813 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011814
11815 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
11816 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011817 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011818
11819 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011820 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011821
11822 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011823 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011824
11825 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
11826 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
11827
11828 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
11829 binary or string samples.
11830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011831 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
11832 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011834 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
11835 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
11836 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011838 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
11839 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011841 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
11842 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011844 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
11845 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011847 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
11848 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011849 This may be used with binary or string samples.
11850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011851 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
11852 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
11853 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011854
11855For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
11856request, it is possible to do :
11857
11858 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
11859
11860In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
11861buffer, one would use the following acl :
11862
11863 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
11864
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011865On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
11866possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
11867
11868 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
11869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011870All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
11871criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
11872method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
11873to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
11874criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
11875the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011877If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011878the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
11879For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011881 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
11882 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
11883 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
11884 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011885
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011886
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011887The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
11888types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
11889combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
11890brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
11891default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011893 +-------------------------------------------------+
11894 | Input sample type |
11895 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011896 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011897 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11898 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
11899 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011900 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011901 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011902 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011903 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011904 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011905 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011906 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011907 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011908 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011909 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011910 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011911 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011912 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011913 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011914 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011915 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011916 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011917 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011918 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011919 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011920 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011921 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11922 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
11923 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011924
11925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200119267.1.1. Matching booleans
11927------------------------
11928
11929In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
11930Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
11931When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
11932that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
11933
11934Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
11935return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
11936"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
11937
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200119397.1.2. Matching integers
11940------------------------
11941
11942Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
11943enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
11944to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
11945
11946Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
11947matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
11948lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011949
11950For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
11951unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
11952representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
11953
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011954As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
11955two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
11956instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
11957ranges and operators.
11958
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011959For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011960operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
11961Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
11962of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011963
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011964Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011965
11966 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
11967 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
11968 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
11969 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
11970 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
11971
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011972For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011973
11974 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
11975
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011976This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
11977
11978 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
11979
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200119817.1.3. Matching strings
11982-----------------------
11983
11984String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
11985different forms :
11986
11987 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
11988 patterns ;
11989
11990 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
11991 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
11992
11993 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
11994 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11995
11996 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
11997 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11998
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010011999 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012000 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12001 matches.
12002
12003 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12004 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12005 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012006
12007String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12008exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12009characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12010string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12011to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012012before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012013
12014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200120157.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12016---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012017
12018Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12019they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12020possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12021passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12022the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012023the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12024match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012025
12026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200120277.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12028-------------------------------------
12029
12030It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12031not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12032a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12033to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12034digits may be used upper or lower case.
12035
12036Example :
12037 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12038 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12039
12040
120417.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12042---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012043
12044IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12045netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12046within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012047host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012048difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12049at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12050does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12051parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012052
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012053The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12054abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12055
12056 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12057 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12058 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12059 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12060 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12061 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12062 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12063 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12064
12065Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12066192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12067
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012068IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12069Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12070trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12071IPv6 patterns.
12072
12073HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12074following situations :
12075 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12076 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12077 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12078 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12079 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12080 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12081 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12082 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12083 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12084 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012086
120877.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12088----------------------------------
12089
12090Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12091combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12092
12093 - AND (implicit)
12094 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12095 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012097A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012099 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012101Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12102indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012104For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12105"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12106requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12107is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12108
12109 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
12110 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12111 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
12112 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
12113
12114To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
12115and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
12116
12117 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
12118 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
12119 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12120 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12121
12122 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
12123 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12124 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12125 use_backend www if host_www
12126
12127It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12128expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
12129be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
12130the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
12131
12132 The following rule :
12133
12134 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
12135 block if METH_POST missing_cl
12136
12137 Can also be written that way :
12138
12139 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
12140
12141It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
12142to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
12143simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
12144sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
12145good use is the following :
12146
12147 With named ACLs :
12148
12149 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
12150 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
12151 monitor fail if site_dead
12152
12153 With anonymous ACLs :
12154
12155 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
12156
12157See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
12158
12159
121607.3. Fetching samples
12161---------------------
12162
12163Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
12164against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
12165sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
12166ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
12167of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
12168available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
12169
12170This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
12171Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
12172compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
12173deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
12174
12175The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
12176matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
12177method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
12178indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
12179
12180As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
12181when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
12182mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
12183the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
12184ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
12185
12186Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
12187multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
12188when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
12189incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
12190are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
12191is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
12192all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
12193
12194Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
12195 - name
12196 - name(arg1)
12197 - name(arg1,arg2)
12198
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012199
122007.3.1. Converters
12201-----------------
12202
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012203Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
12204of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
12205is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
12206was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
12207has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
12208unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
12209
12210These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
12211sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
12212the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
12213support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012214
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012215A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
12216support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
12217supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
12218(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
12219bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
12220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012221The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012222
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001222351d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
12224 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
12225 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
12226 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
12227 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
12228 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
12229
12230 Example :
12231 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
12232 # containg values for the three properties requested by using the
12233 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
12234 frontend http-in
12235 bind *:8081
12236 default_backend servers
12237 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
12238 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
12239
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012240add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012241 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012242 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012243 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
12244 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012245 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012246 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12247 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12248 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12249 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12250 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012251 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012252
12253and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012254 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012255 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012256 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12257 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012258 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012259 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12260 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12261 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12262 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12263 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012264 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012265
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012266base64
12267 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
12268 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
12269 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
12270
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012271bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012272 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012273 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12274 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12275 presence of a flag).
12276
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012277bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
12278 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
12279 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012280 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012281
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012282cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012283 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
12284 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012285
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012286crc32([<avalanche>])
12287 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
12288 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12289 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12290 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12291 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12292 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
12293 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
12294 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
12295 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
12296 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
12297 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
12298
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010012299da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012300 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
12301 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
12302 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
12303 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012304 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012305 configuration language.
12306
12307 Example:
12308 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020012309 bind *:8881
12310 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012311 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012312
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020012313debug
12314 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
12315 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
12316 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
12317
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012318div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012319 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12320 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012321 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012322 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12323 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012324 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012325 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12326 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12327 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12328 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12329 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012330 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012331
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012332djb2([<avalanche>])
12333 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
12334 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12335 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12336 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12337 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12338 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12339 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012340 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
12341 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012342
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012343even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012344 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012345 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
12346
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010012347field(<index>,<delimiters>)
12348 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
12349 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
12350 list of chars.
12351
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012352hex
12353 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
12354 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
12355 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
12356 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010012357
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012358http_date([<offset>])
12359 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12360 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
12361 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
12362 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
12363 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
12364 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012365
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012366in_table(<table>)
12367 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12368 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
12369 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
12370 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
12371 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
12372
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012373ipmask(<mask>)
12374 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
12375 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
12376 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
12377 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
12378
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012379json([<input-code>])
12380 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
12381 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012382 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012383 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
12384 of errors:
12385 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
12386 bytes, ...)
12387 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
12388 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
12389
12390 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
12391 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
12392 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
12393 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
12394 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
12395 are :
12396 - "ascii" : never fails ;
12397 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
12398 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
12399 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
12400 error ;
12401 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
12402 characters corresponding to the other errors.
12403
12404 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
12405 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
12406
12407 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012408 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012409 capture request header user-agent len 150
12410 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012411
12412 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
12413 GET / HTTP/1.0
12414 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
12415
12416 Output log:
12417 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
12418
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012419language(<value>[,<default>])
12420 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
12421 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
12422 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
12423 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
12424 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
12425 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
12426 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
12427 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
12428 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
12429 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
12430 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
12431 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012432
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012433 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012434
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012435 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
12436 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012437
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012438 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
12439 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
12440 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
12441 use_backend spanish if es
12442 use_backend french if fr
12443 use_backend english if en
12444 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012445
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012446lower
12447 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
12448 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12449 type. The result is of type string.
12450
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012451ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
12452 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12453 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
12454 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12455 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12456 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12457 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
12458
12459 Example :
12460
12461 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
12462 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12463 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12464
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012465map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12466map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12467map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12468 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
12469 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
12470 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
12471 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
12472 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
12473 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
12474 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
12475 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012476
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012477 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
12478 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
12479 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012480
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012481 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012482 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012483
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012484 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
12485 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12486 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
12487 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020012488 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
12489 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012490 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
12491 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12492 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
12493 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12494 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
12495 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12496 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
12497 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080012498 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
12499 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12500 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012501 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12502 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
12503 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12504 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
12505 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012506
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012507 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
12508 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
12509 the corresponding match text.
12510
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012511 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
12512 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
12513 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
12514 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
12515 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012516
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012517 Example :
12518
12519 # this is a comment and is ignored
12520 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
12521 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
12522 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
12523 | | | `---------- value
12524 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
12525 | `---------------------------- key
12526 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
12527
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012528mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012529 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12530 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012531 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012532 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012533 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012534 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12535 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12536 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12537 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12538 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012539 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012540
12541mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012542 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020012543 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
12544 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012545 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012546 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012547 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012548 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12549 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12550 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12551 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12552 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012553 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012554
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010012555nbsrv
12556 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
12557 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
12558 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
12559 map lookup.
12560
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012561neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012562 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
12563 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
12564 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
12565 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012566
12567not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012568 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012569 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12570 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12571 absence of a flag).
12572
12573odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012574 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012575 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
12576
12577or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012578 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012579 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012580 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12581 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012582 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012583 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12584 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12585 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12586 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12587 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012588 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012589
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010012590regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012591 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
12592 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
12593 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
12594 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
12595 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
12596 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
12597 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
12598 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
12599 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
12600 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010012601 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
12602 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
12603 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
12604 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012605
12606 Example :
12607
12608 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
12609 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
12610 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
12611 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
12612
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012613capture-req(<id>)
12614 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
12615 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12616
12617 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012618 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12619 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012620
12621capture-res(<id>)
12622 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
12623 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12624
12625 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012626 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12627 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012628
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012629sdbm([<avalanche>])
12630 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
12631 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12632 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12633 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12634 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12635 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12636 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012637 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
12638 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012639
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012640set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012641 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
12642 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
12643 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012644 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012645 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12646 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012647 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012648 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12649 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012650 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012651 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012652
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012653sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012654 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
12655 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012656 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012657 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12658 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012659 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012660 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12661 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012662 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012663 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12664 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012665 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012666 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012667
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012668table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
12669 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12670 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12671 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
12672 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12673 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12674 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
12675
12676
12677table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
12678 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12679 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12680 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
12681 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12682 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12683 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
12684
12685table_conn_cnt(<table>)
12686 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12687 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12688 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12689 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
12690 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12691
12692table_conn_cur(<table>)
12693 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12694 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12695 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12696 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12697 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
12698
12699table_conn_rate(<table>)
12700 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12701 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12702 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
12703 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12704 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
12705
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012706table_gpt0(<table>)
12707 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12708 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
12709 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12710 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12711 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
12712
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012713table_gpc0(<table>)
12714 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12715 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12716 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12717 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
12718 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
12719
12720table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
12721 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12722 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12723 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
12724 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
12725 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
12726 sample fetch keyword.
12727
12728table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
12729 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12730 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12731 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12732 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12733 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12734
12735table_http_err_rate(<table>)
12736 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12737 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12738 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
12739 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
12740 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
12741 keyword.
12742
12743table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
12744 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12745 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12746 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12747 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
12748 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12749
12750table_http_req_rate(<table>)
12751 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12752 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12753 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
12754 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
12755 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
12756 keyword.
12757
12758table_kbytes_in(<table>)
12759 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12760 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12761 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
12762 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12763 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12764 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
12765 keyword.
12766
12767table_kbytes_out(<table>)
12768 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12769 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12770 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
12771 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12772 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12773 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
12774 keyword.
12775
12776table_server_id(<table>)
12777 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12778 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12779 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
12780 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
12781 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
12782 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
12783
12784table_sess_cnt(<table>)
12785 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12786 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12787 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12788 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
12789 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12790 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
12791 keyword.
12792
12793table_sess_rate(<table>)
12794 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12795 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12796 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
12797 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
12798 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12799 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
12800 keyword.
12801
12802table_trackers(<table>)
12803 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12804 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12805 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12806 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
12807 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
12808 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
12809 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
12810 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
12811 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
12812 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
12813
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012814upper
12815 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
12816 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12817 type. The result is of type string.
12818
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020012819url_dec
12820 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
12821 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
12822
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012823unset-var(<var name>)
12824 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
12825 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12826 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
12827 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12828 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
12829 response),
12830 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12831 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
12832 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12833 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
12834
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012835utime(<format>[,<offset>])
12836 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12837 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
12838 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12839 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12840 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12841 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
12842
12843 Example :
12844
12845 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
12846 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12847 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12848
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010012849word(<index>,<delimiters>)
12850 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
12851 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
12852
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012853wt6([<avalanche>])
12854 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
12855 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12856 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12857 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12858 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12859 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12860 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012861 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
12862 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012863
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012864xor(<value>)
12865 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012866 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012867 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012868 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012869 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012870 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12871 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012872 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012873 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12874 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012875 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012876 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012877
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010012878xxh32([<seed>])
12879 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
12880 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
12881 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
12882 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
12883 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
12884 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
12885 as cryptographically secure.
12886
12887xxh64([<seed>])
12888 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
12889 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
12890 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
12891 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
12892 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
12893 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
12894 as cryptographically secure.
12895
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012896
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200128977.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012898--------------------------------------------
12899
12900A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
12901not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
12902"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
12903The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
12904
12905always_false : boolean
12906 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12907 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12908
12909always_true : boolean
12910 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12911 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12912
12913avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012914 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012915 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
12916 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
12917 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
12918 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
12919 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
12920 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
12921 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
12922 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
12923 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
12924 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
12925 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
12926 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
12927 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010012928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012929be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012930 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
12931 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
12932 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
12933 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
12934 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012936be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
12937 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12938 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12939 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
12940 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
12941 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
12942 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012943
12944 Example :
12945 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
12946 backend dynamic
12947 mode http
12948 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
12949 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012950
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012951bin(<hexa>) : bin
12952 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
12953 of the string.
12954
12955bool(<bool>) : bool
12956 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
12957 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
12958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012959connslots([<backend>]) : integer
12960 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012961 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012962 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
12963 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050012964
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012965 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012966 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012967 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
12968
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012969 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
12970 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012971
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012972 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012973 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012974 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012975 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
12976 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012977 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012978 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012979
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012980 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
12981 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012982 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012983 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012984
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012985date([<offset>]) : integer
12986 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
12987 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
12988 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
12989 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020012990 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
12991
12992 Example :
12993
12994 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
12995 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012996
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020012997env(<name>) : string
12998 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
12999 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
13000 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
13001 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
13002 certain way.
13003
13004 Examples :
13005 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
13006 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
13007
13008 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
13009 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
13010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013011fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
13012 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013013 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
13014 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013015 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
13016 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
13017 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
13018 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
13019 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013020
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020013021fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13022 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
13023 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
13024 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
13025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013026fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13027 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13028 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13029 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
13030 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
13031 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
13032 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
13033 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
13034 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013035
13036 Example :
13037 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
13038 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
13039 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
13040 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
13041 frontend mail
13042 bind :25
13043 mode tcp
13044 maxconn 100
13045 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
13046 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
13047 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
13048 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013049
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010013050hostname : string
13051 Returns the system hostname.
13052
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013053int(<integer>) : signed integer
13054 Returns a signed integer.
13055
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013056ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
13057 Returns an ipv4.
13058
13059ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
13060 Returns an ipv6.
13061
13062meth(<method>) : method
13063 Returns a method.
13064
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013065nbproc : integer
13066 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
13067 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
13068 and debugging purposes.
13069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013070nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
13071 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
13072 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
13073 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013074 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
13075 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
13076 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013077
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013078proc : integer
13079 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
13080 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
13081 debugging purposes.
13082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013083queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013084 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
13085 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
13086 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013087 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
13088 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
13089 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
13090 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
13091 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
13092
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010013093rand([<range>]) : integer
13094 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
13095 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
13096 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
13097 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
13098 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
13099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013100srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13101 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13102 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
13103 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
13104 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
13105 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
13106 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
13107 methods.
13108
13109srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
13110 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
13111 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
13112 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
13113 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
13114 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
13115 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
13116 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
13117
13118srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13119 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13120 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013121 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013122 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
13123 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
13124 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
13125 overloading servers).
13126
13127 Example :
13128 # Redirect to a separate back
13129 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
13130 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
13131 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
13132
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013133stopping : boolean
13134 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
13135 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
13136 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
13137
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013138str(<string>) : string
13139 Returns a string.
13140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013141table_avl([<table>]) : integer
13142 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
13143 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
13144
13145table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13146 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
13147 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
13148 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
13149
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013150var(<var-name>) : undefined
13151 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013152 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
13153 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013154 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013155 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13156 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013157 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013158 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13159 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013160 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013161 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013162
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200131637.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013164----------------------------------
13165
13166The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
13167closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
13168methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
13169sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
13170TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013171the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
13172counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
13173"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013174argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
13175the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
13176this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013177
13178be_id : integer
13179 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
13180 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13181
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013182be_name : string
13183 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
13184 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013186dst : ip
13187 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
13188 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
13189 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
13190 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
13191 RFC 4291.
13192
13193dst_conn : integer
13194 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13195 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
13196 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
13197 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
13198 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
13199 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
13200 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
13201 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013202
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013203dst_is_local : boolean
13204 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
13205 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
13206 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
13207 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
13208 targetting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
13209 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
13210 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
13211 it only once per connection.
13212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013213dst_port : integer
13214 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
13215 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
13216 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
13217 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
13218 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
13219 an HTTP header.
13220
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010013221fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
13222 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
13223 header.
13224
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020013225fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
13226 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
13227 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
13228 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
13229 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13230 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13231 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13232
13233fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
13234 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
13235 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
13236 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
13237 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13238 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13239 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13240
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070013241fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
13242 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13243 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13244 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13245 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13246
13247fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
13248 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13249 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13250 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13251 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13252
13253fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
13254 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
13255 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13256 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13257 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13258
13259fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
13260 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
13261 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13262 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13263 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13264
13265fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
13266 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
13267 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13268 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13269 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13270
13271fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
13272 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
13273 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13274 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13275 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013277fe_id : integer
13278 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010013279 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013280 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13281
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013282fe_name : string
13283 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
13284 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
13285 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13286
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013287sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013288sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13289sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13290sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013291 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
13292 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13293 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
13294
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013295sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013296sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13297sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13298sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013299 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
13300 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13301 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
13302
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013303sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013304sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13305sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13306sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013307 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
13308 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013309 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
13310 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
13311 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013312
13313 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13314 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013315 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13316 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
13317 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013318 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13319 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13320
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013321sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013322sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13323sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13324sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013325 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
13326 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
13327
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013328sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013329sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13330sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13331sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013332 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13333 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
13334 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
13335
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013336sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013337sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13338sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13339sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013340 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
13341 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
13342 See also src_conn_rate.
13343
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013344sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013345sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13346sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13347sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013348 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013349 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013350
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013351sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
13352sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13353sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13354sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13355 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13356 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
13357
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013358sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013359sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13360sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13361sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013362 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
13363 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
13364 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013365 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13366 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13367 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013368
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013369sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013370sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13371sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13372sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013373 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
13374 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
13375 See also src_http_err_cnt.
13376
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013377sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013378sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13379sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13380sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013381 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
13382 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13383 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
13384 src_http_err_rate.
13385
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013386sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013387sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13388sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13389sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013390 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13391 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13392 src_http_req_cnt.
13393
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013394sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013395sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13396sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13397sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013398 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13399 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
13400 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13401 src_http_req_rate.
13402
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013403sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013404sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13405sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13406sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013407 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013408 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
13409 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
13410 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
13411 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013412
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013413 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13414 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013415 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13416
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013417sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013418sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13419sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13420sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013421 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
13422 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13423 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013424
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013425sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013426sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13427sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13428sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013429 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
13430 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13431 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013432
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013433sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013434sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13435sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13436sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013437 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
13438 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
13439 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
13440 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013441 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013442 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
13443
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013444sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013445sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13446sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13447sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013448 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
13449 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13450 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
13451 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
13452 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013453 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013454
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013455sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013456sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13457sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13458sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020013459 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
13460 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
13461 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
13462
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013463sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013464sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13465sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13466sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013467 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13468 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013469 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013470 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
13471 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013472 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
13473 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
13474 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013476so_id : integer
13477 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
13478 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
13479 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013481src : ip
13482 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
13483 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
13484 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
13485 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013486 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
13487 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
13488 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
13489 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013490
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013491 Example:
13492 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
13493 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
13494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013495src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13496 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
13497 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
13498 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013499 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013501src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13502 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
13503 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013504 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013505 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013507src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13508 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13509 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13510 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
13511 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
13512 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
13513 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013514
13515 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13516 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
13517 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
13518 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013519 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013520 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13521 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013523src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013524 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013525 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013526 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013527 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013529src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013530 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013531 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
13532 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013533 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013535src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13536 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
13537 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13538 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013539 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013541src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013542 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013543 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013544 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013545 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013546
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013547src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13548 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13549 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
13550 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
13551 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
13552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013553src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013554 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013555 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013556 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
13557 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013558 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13559 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13560 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013562src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13563 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
13564 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013565 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013566 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013567 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013569src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13570 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
13571 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13572 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13573 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013574 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013576src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13577 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13578 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13579 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013580 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013582src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13583 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13584 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13585 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013586 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013587 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013589src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13590 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13591 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13592 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013593 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013594 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
13595 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013596
13597 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013598 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013599 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013600
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013601src_is_local : boolean
13602 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
13603 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
13604 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
13605 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
13606 client comes from (eg: require auth or https for remote machines). Please
13607 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
13608 once per connection.
13609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013610src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013611 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
13612 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
13613 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
13614 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
13615 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013617src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013618 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
13619 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13620 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
13621 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
13622 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013624src_port : integer
13625 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
13626 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
13627 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
13628 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013630src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13631 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013632 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13633 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
13634 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013635 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013637src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13638 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
13639 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13640 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13641 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013642 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013644src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13645 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
13646 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
13647 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
13648 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
13649 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
13650 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
13651 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
13652 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013653
13654 Example :
13655 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
13656 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
13657 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
13658 listen ssh
13659 bind :22
13660 mode tcp
13661 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013662 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013663 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013664 server local 127.0.0.1:22
13665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013666srv_id : integer
13667 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
13668 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
13669 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020013670
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200136717.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013672----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020013673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013674The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
13675closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
13676when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
13677usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013678future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013679
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001368051d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
13681 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13682 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13683 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
13684 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13685 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13686
13687 Example :
13688 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
13689 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
13690 # the request.
13691 frontend http-in
13692 bind *:8081
13693 default_backend servers
13694 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13695 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13696
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013697ssl_bc : boolean
13698 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13699 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
13700 other a server with the "ssl" option.
13701
13702ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
13703 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
13704 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13705
13706ssl_bc_cipher : string
13707 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
13708 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13709
13710ssl_bc_protocol : string
13711 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
13712 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13713
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013714ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013715 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013716 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13717 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013718
13719ssl_bc_session_id : binary
13720 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
13721 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
13722 if session was reused or not.
13723
13724ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
13725 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
13726 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013728ssl_c_ca_err : integer
13729 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13730 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
13731 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
13732 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
13733 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013735ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
13736 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13737 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
13738 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
13739 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013740
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013741ssl_c_der : binary
13742 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
13743 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13744 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013746ssl_c_err : integer
13747 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13748 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
13749 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
13750 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
13751 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013753ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13754 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13755 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13756 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13757 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13758 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13759 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13760 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13761 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013763ssl_c_key_alg : string
13764 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13765 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13766 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013768ssl_c_notafter : string
13769 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
13770 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13771 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013773ssl_c_notbefore : string
13774 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
13775 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13776 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013778ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13779 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13780 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13781 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13782 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13783 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13784 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13785 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13786 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013788ssl_c_serial : binary
13789 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
13790 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13791 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013793ssl_c_sha1 : binary
13794 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
13795 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
13796 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020013797 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
13798 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
13799
13800 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013802ssl_c_sig_alg : string
13803 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13804 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13805 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013807ssl_c_used : boolean
13808 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
13809 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013811ssl_c_verify : integer
13812 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
13813 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
13814 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
13815 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013817ssl_c_version : integer
13818 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
13819 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013820
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013821ssl_f_der : binary
13822 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
13823 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13824 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013826ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13827 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13828 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13829 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13830 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013831 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013832 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13833 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13834 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013836ssl_f_key_alg : string
13837 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13838 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
13839 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013841ssl_f_notafter : string
13842 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13843 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13844 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013846ssl_f_notbefore : string
13847 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13848 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13849 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013851ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13852 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13853 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13854 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13855 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13856 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13857 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13858 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13859 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013861ssl_f_serial : binary
13862 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13863 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13864 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013865
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020013866ssl_f_sha1 : binary
13867 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
13868 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
13869 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
13870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013871ssl_f_sig_alg : string
13872 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13873 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13874 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013876ssl_f_version : integer
13877 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13878 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13879
13880ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013881 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13882 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
13883 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
13884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013885 Example :
13886 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
13887 listen http-https
13888 bind :80
13889 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
13890 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
13891
13892ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
13893 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
13894 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13895
13896ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013897 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013898 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
13899 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
13900 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
13901 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
13902 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
13903 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
13904 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
13905 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
13906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013907ssl_fc_cipher : string
13908 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
13909 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013910
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010013911ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
13912 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
13913 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010013914 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010013915
13916ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
13917 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
13918 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010013919 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010013920
13921ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
13922 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
13923 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
13924 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
13925 avaible with OpenSSL > 1.0.2 compiled with the option enable-ssl-trace.
13926 If the function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash
13927 like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
13928
13929ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
13930 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
13931 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010013932 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010013933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013934ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013935 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
13936 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010013937 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
13938 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
13939 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
13940 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013942ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
13943 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020013944 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
13945 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
13946 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13947 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013948
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020013949ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020013950 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
13951 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
13952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013953ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013954 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013955 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
13956 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
13957 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13958 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
13959 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
13960 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
13961 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020013962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013963ssl_fc_protocol : string
13964 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
13965 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013966
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013967ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013968 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013969 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13970 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013972ssl_fc_session_id : binary
13973 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
13974 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
13975 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
13976 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013978ssl_fc_sni : string
13979 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
13980 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
13981 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
13982 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
13983 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
13984
13985 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
13986 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
13987 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020013988 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
13989 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013991 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013992 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
13993 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020013994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013995ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
13996 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
13997 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013998
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013999
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200140007.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014001------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014003Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
14004sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
14005only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
14006For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
14007be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
14008can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
14009sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
14010for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
14011content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014013payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
14014 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
14015 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
14016 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014018payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
14019 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
14020 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
14021 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014023req.len : integer
14024req_len : integer (deprecated)
14025 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14026 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14027 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14028 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14029 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14030 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14031 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
14032 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014034req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14035 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014036 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14037 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14038 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14039 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014041 ACL alternatives :
14042 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014044req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14045 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14046 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14047 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
14048 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014050 ACL alternatives :
14051 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014053 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014055req.proto_http : boolean
14056req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
14057 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
14058 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
14059 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
14060 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
14061 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
14062 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
14063 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014065 Example:
14066 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
14067 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14068 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014069 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014071req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
14072rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14073 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
14074 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
14075 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
14076 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
14077 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
14078 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
14079 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014081 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
14082 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
14083 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
14084 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
14085 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
14086 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014088 ACL derivatives :
14089 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014091 Example :
14092 listen tse-farm
14093 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
14094 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
14095 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14096 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
14097 # apply RDP cookie persistence
14098 persist rdp-cookie
14099 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
14100 # This is only useful makes sense if
14101 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
14102 stick-table type string size 204800
14103 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
14104 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
14105 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014107 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
14108 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014110req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
14111rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
14112 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
14113 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
14114 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
14115 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014117 ACL derivatives :
14118 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014119
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014120req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
14121 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
14122 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014123 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
14124 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
14125 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
14126 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
14127 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014129req.ssl_hello_type : integer
14130req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14131 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14132 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
14133 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14134 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14135 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
14136 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14137 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014139req.ssl_sni : string
14140req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
14141 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
14142 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
14143 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
14144 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14145 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14146 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
14147 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
14148 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
14149 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
14150 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
14151 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
14152 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014154 ACL derivatives :
14155 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014157 Examples :
14158 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
14159 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14160 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
14161 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
14162 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014163
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053014164req.ssl_st_ext : integer
14165 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
14166 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
14167 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
14168 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
14169 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
14170 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
14171 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
14172 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
14173 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
14174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014175req.ssl_ver : integer
14176req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
14177 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
14178 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
14179 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
14180 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
14181 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14182 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14183 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
14184 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
14185 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014187 ACL derivatives :
14188 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014189
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020014190res.len : integer
14191 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14192 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14193 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14194 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14195 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14196 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14197 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
14198 content inspection.
14199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014200res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14201 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014202 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14203 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14204 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14205 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014207res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14208 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14209 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14210 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
14211 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014213 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014214
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020014215res.ssl_hello_type : integer
14216rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14217 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14218 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
14219 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14220 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14221 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
14222 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14223 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
14224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014225wait_end : boolean
14226 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
14227 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
14228 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
14229 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
14230 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
14231 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
14232 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
14233 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014235 Examples :
14236 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
14237 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
14238 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014240 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
14241 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14242 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
14243 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
14244 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
14245 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
14246 tcp-request content reject
14247
14248
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200142497.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014250--------------------------------------
14251
14252It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
14253This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
14254data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
14255its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
14256HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
14257content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
14258to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
14259more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
14260response are indexed.
14261
14262base : string
14263 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
14264 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
14265 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
14266 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
14267 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
14268 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
14269 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
14270 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
14271
14272 ACL derivatives :
14273 base : exact string match
14274 base_beg : prefix match
14275 base_dir : subdir match
14276 base_dom : domain match
14277 base_end : suffix match
14278 base_len : length match
14279 base_reg : regex match
14280 base_sub : substring match
14281
14282base32 : integer
14283 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
14284 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
14285 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014286 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
14287 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
14288 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014289
14290base32+src : binary
14291 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
14292 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
14293 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
14294 per-URL counters.
14295
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014296capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
14297 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
14298 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14299 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
14300
14301capture.req.method : string
14302 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
14303 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
14304 because it's allocated.
14305
14306capture.req.uri : string
14307 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
14308 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
14309 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
14310 allocated.
14311
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014312capture.req.ver : string
14313 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14314 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
14315 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
14316
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014317capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
14318 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
14319 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14320 The first entry is an index of 0.
14321 See also: "capture response header"
14322
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014323capture.res.ver : string
14324 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14325 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
14326 persistent flag.
14327
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014328req.body : binary
14329 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
14330 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14331 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
14332 the first chunk is analyzed.
14333
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020014334req.body_param([<name>) : string
14335 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
14336 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
14337 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
14338 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
14339 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
14340 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
14341 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
14342 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
14343 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
14344 given.
14345
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014346req.body_len : integer
14347 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
14348 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
14349 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14350 "option http-buffer-request".
14351
14352req.body_size : integer
14353 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
14354 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
14355 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
14356 that the request body has been buffered made available using
14357 "option http-buffer-request".
14358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014359req.cook([<name>]) : string
14360cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14361 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14362 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14363 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
14364 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
14365 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
14366 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
14367 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
14368 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
14369
14370 ACL derivatives :
14371 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
14372 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
14373 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
14374 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
14375 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
14376 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
14377 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
14378 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014380req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14381cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14382 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14383 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014385req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14386cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14387 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14388 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
14389 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
14390 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014392cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14393 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14394 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
14395 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
14396 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014397 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014398 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
14399 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
14400 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
14401 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014403hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14404 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
14405 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
14406 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
14407 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014408 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014410req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
14411 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14412 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14413 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14414 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14415 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14416 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
14417 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
14418 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014420req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14421 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14422 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14423 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14424 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014426req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14427 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14428 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14429 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14430 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14431 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14432 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
14433 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
14434 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
14435 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
14436 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
14437 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014439 ACL derivatives :
14440 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14441 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14442 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14443 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14444 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14445 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14446 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14447 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14448
14449req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14450hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
14451 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14452 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
14453 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
14454 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
14455 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
14456 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
14457 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
14458 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
14459 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
14460
14461req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14462hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14463 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
14464 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
14465 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
14466 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14467 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14468 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14469 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
14470 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
14471
14472req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14473hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14474 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
14475 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
14476 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
14477 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14478 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14479 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14480 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
14481
14482http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
14483 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
14484 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
14485 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14486 basic auth is supported.
14487
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014488http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
14489 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
14490 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
14491 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
14492 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014493 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14494 basic auth is supported.
14495
14496 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014497 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
14498 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
14499 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
14500 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014501
14502http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014503 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
14504 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014505 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
14506 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014508method : integer + string
14509 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
14510 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
14511 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
14512 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
14513 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
14514 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
14515 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014517 ACL derivatives :
14518 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014520 Example :
14521 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
14522 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
14523 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014525path : string
14526 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
14527 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
14528 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
14529 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
14530 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
14531 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
14532 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014534 ACL derivatives :
14535 path : exact string match
14536 path_beg : prefix match
14537 path_dir : subdir match
14538 path_dom : domain match
14539 path_end : suffix match
14540 path_len : length match
14541 path_reg : regex match
14542 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014543
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014544query : string
14545 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
14546 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
14547 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
14548 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014549 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014550 which stops before the question mark.
14551
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014552req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14553 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14554 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14555 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14556 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014558req.ver : string
14559req_ver : string (deprecated)
14560 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
14561 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
14562 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014564 ACL derivatives :
14565 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014567res.comp : boolean
14568 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
14569 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
14570 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014572res.comp_algo : string
14573 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
14574 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
14575 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014577res.cook([<name>]) : string
14578scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14579 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14580 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14581 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014583 ACL derivatives :
14584 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014586res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14587scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14588 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14589 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
14590 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014592res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14593scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14594 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14595 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
14596 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014598res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14599 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14600 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14601 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14602 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14603 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
14604 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
14605 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
14606 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
14607 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014609res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14610 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14611 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14612 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14613 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
14614 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014616res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14617shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
14618 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14619 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14620 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14621 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14622 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
14623 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
14624 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
14625 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014627 ACL derivatives :
14628 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14629 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14630 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14631 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14632 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14633 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14634 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14635 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14636
14637res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14638shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14639 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14640 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14641 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
14642 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
14643 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014645res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14646shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14647 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
14648 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
14649 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
14650 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
14651 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
14652 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014653
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014654res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14655 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14656 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14657 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14658 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014660res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14661shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14662 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
14663 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14664 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14665 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14666 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
14667 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014669res.ver : string
14670resp_ver : string (deprecated)
14671 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
14672 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014674 ACL derivatives :
14675 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014677set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14678 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14679 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014680 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014681 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014683 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
14684 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014686status : integer
14687 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
14688 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
14689 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014690
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020014691unique-id : string
14692 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
14693 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
14694 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
14695 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
14696 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
14697 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
14698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014699url : string
14700 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
14701 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
14702 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
14703 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
14704 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
14705 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
14706 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014708 ACL derivatives :
14709 url : exact string match
14710 url_beg : prefix match
14711 url_dir : subdir match
14712 url_dom : domain match
14713 url_end : suffix match
14714 url_len : length match
14715 url_reg : regex match
14716 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014718url_ip : ip
14719 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
14720 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
14721 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
14722 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
14723 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
14724 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14725 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014727url_port : integer
14728 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
14729 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
14730 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14731 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014732
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014733urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
14734url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014735 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
14736 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014737 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
14738 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
14739 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
14740 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014741 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
14742 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014743 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
14744 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014746 ACL derivatives :
14747 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
14748 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
14749 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
14750 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
14751 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
14752 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
14753 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
14754 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014755
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014757 Example :
14758 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
14759 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
14760 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
14761 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014762
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014763urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>])] : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014764 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
14765 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
14766 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020014767
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020014768url32 : integer
14769 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
14770 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
14771 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
14772 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
14773 is an unsigned integer.
14774
14775url32+src : binary
14776 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
14777 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
14778 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
14779
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010014780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200147817.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014782---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014783
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014784Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
14785every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020014786order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014787
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014788ACL name Equivalent to Usage
14789---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014790FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020014791HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014792HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
14793HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014794HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
14795HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
14796HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
14797HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
14798LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014799METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014800METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014801METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
14802METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
14803METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
14804METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014805METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014806METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014807RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014808REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014809TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014810WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
14811---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014812
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010014813
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148148. Logging
14815----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014816
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014817One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
14818provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
14819very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
14820provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
14821state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014822to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014823headers.
14824
14825In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
14826about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
14827send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
14828
14829 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
14830 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
14831 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
14832 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
14833 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060014834 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
14835 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014836
14837The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
14838allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
14839as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
14840while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
14841real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
14842delay.
14843
14844
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148458.1. Log levels
14846---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014847
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014848TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014849source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014850HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
14851in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
14852track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
14853syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
14854about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014855
14856
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148578.2. Log formats
14858----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014859
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014860HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014861and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
14862slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
14863options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014864
14865 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
14866 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
14867 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
14868 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
14869 extents.
14870
14871 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
14872 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
14873 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
14874 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
14875 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
14876
14877 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
14878 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
14879 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
14880 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
14881 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
14882
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020014883 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
14884 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
14885 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
14886 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
14887
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014888 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
14889
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014890Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
14891specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
14892field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
14893servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
14894always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
14895identifier.
14896
14897Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
14898 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
14899 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
14900 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
14901 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
14902
14903
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149048.2.1. Default log format
14905-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014906
14907This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
14908as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
14909format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
14910
14911 Example :
14912 listen www
14913 mode http
14914 log global
14915 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14916
14917 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
14918 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
14919 (www/HTTP)
14920
14921 Field Format Extract from the example above
14922 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
14923 2 'Connect from' Connect from
14924 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
14925 4 'to' to
14926 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
14927 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
14928
14929Detailed fields description :
14930 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
14931 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
14932 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
14933 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
14934 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14935 and processed the connection.
14936 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
14937
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014938In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
14939"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
14940connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
14941
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014942It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
14943will eventually disappear.
14944
14945
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149468.2.2. TCP log format
14947---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014948
14949The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
14950is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
14951information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
14952counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
14953emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
14954environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
14955the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
14956sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014957specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
14958not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
14959fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
14960marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014961
14962 Example :
14963 frontend fnt
14964 mode tcp
14965 option tcplog
14966 log global
14967 default_backend bck
14968
14969 backend bck
14970 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14971
14972 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
14973 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
14974 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
14975
14976 Field Format Extract from the example above
14977 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
14978 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
14979 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
14980 4 frontend_name fnt
14981 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
14982 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
14983 7 bytes_read* 212
14984 8 termination_state --
14985 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
14986 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14987
14988Detailed fields description :
14989 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014990 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14991 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14992 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014993 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
14994 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
14995 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014996
14997 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014998 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14999 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15000 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015001
15002 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
15003 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
15004 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
15005 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
15006
15007 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15008 and processed the connection.
15009
15010 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15011 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15012 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
15013 applications.
15014
15015 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15016 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15017 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15018 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
15019 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
15020
15021 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15022 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15023 See "Timers" below for more details.
15024
15025 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15026 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15027 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
15028 "Timers" below for more details.
15029
15030 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015031 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015032 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
15033 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
15034 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
15035 details.
15036
15037 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
15038 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
15039 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
15040 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
15041 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
15042
15043 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15044 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15045 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
15046 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
15047 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
15048 for more details.
15049
15050 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015051 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015052 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
15053 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
15054 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015055 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015056
15057 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15058 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15059 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15060 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15061 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15062 caused by a denial of service attack.
15063
15064 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15065 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15066 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15067 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15068 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15069 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15070 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15071 denial of service attack.
15072
15073 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15074 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15075 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15076 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15077 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15078 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15079 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15080 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
15081 be processed than on other servers.
15082
15083 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15084 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15085 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15086 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15087 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15088 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15089 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15090 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15091 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15092 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15093 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15094 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15095 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15096
15097 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15098 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15099 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15100 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15101 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15102 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15103 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15104 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15105
15106 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15107 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15108 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15109 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15110 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15111 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15112 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15113 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15114 occurs.
15115
15116
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151178.2.3. HTTP log format
15118----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015119
15120The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
15121is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
15122the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
15123are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
15124emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
15125generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
15126"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
15127which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015128frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
15129is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015130
15131Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
15132slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
15133with a star ('*') after the field name below.
15134
15135 Example :
15136 frontend http-in
15137 mode http
15138 option httplog
15139 log global
15140 default_backend bck
15141
15142 backend static
15143 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15144
15145 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
15146 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
15147 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015148 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015149
15150 Field Format Extract from the example above
15151 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
15152 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015153 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015154 4 frontend_name http-in
15155 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015156 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015157 7 status_code 200
15158 8 bytes_read* 2750
15159 9 captured_request_cookie -
15160 10 captured_response_cookie -
15161 11 termination_state ----
15162 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
15163 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15164 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
15165 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
15166 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015167
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015168Detailed fields description :
15169 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015170 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15171 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15172 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015173 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15174 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15175 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015176
15177 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015178 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15179 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15180 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015181
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015182 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
15183 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015184
15185 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15186 and processed the connection.
15187
15188 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15189 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15190 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
15191
15192 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15193 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15194 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15195 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
15196 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
15197 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
15198
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015199 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
15200 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
15201 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
15202 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
15203 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
15204 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
15205 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015206
15207 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15208 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15209 See "Timers" below for more details.
15210
15211 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15212 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15213 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
15214 below for more details.
15215
15216 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
15217 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
15218 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
15219 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
15220 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
15221 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
15222 for more details.
15223
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015224 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
15225 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
15226 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
15227 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
15228 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
15229 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
15230 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
15231 See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015232
15233 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
15234 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
15235 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
15236
15237 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
15238 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
15239 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
15240 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
15241 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
15242 overflowing.
15243
15244 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
15245 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
15246 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
15247 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
15248 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
15249 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
15250 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
15251 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15252
15253 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
15254 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
15255 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
15256 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
15257 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
15258 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
15259 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
15260 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15261
15262 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15263 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15264 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
15265 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
15266 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
15267 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
15268 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
15269
15270 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015271 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015272 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
15273 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
15274 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015275 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015276 system.
15277
15278 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15279 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15280 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15281 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15282 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15283 caused by a denial of service attack.
15284
15285 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15286 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15287 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15288 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15289 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15290 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15291 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15292 denial of service attack.
15293
15294 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15295 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15296 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15297 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15298 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15299 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15300 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15301 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
15302 processed than on other servers.
15303
15304 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15305 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15306 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15307 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15308 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15309 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15310 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15311 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15312 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15313 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15314 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15315 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15316 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15317
15318 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15319 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15320 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15321 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15322 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15323 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15324 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15325 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15326
15327 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15328 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15329 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15330 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15331 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15332 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15333 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15334 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15335 occurs.
15336
15337 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
15338 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
15339 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
15340 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
15341 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
15342 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
15343 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
15344 cookies" below for more details.
15345
15346 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
15347 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
15348 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
15349 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
15350 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
15351 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
15352 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
15353 and cookies" below for more details.
15354
15355 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
15356 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
15357 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
15358 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
15359 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
15360 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
15361 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
15362 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
15363
15364
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200153658.2.4. Custom log format
15366------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015367
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015368The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015369mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015370
15371HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
15372Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
15373separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
15374prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
15375
15376Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
15377variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015378("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015379
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015380If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020015381as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015382less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
15383the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
15384
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015385Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015386In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010015387in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015388
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015389Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
15390'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
15391https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
15392such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
15393
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015394Flags are :
15395 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015396 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015397 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
15398 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015399
15400 Example:
15401
15402 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
15403 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
15404
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015405 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
15406
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015407At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
15408
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015409 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
15410 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015411
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015412the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015413
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015414 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
15415 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
15416 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015417
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015418and the default TCP format is defined this way :
15419
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015420 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
15421 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015422
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015423Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
15424
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015425 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015426 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015427 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
15428 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
15429 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015430 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
15431 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
15432 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015433 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015434 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
15435 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000015436 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015437 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
15438 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010015439 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020015440 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015441 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015442 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015443 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020015444 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080015445 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015446 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
15447 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
15448 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
15449 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
15450 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015451 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015452 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
15453 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015454 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015455 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
15456 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015457 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15458 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
15459 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015460 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015461 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
15462 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015463 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015464 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15465 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
15466 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020015467 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020015468 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015469 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
15470 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
15471 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
15472 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020015473 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015474 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015475 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015476 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010015477 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015478 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015479 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
15480 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
15481 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015482 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015483 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
15484 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015485 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015486 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
15487 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
15488 | H | %trl | locla_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015489 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015490 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015491 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015492
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015493 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015494
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010015495
154968.2.5. Error log format
15497-----------------------
15498
15499When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
15500protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
15501By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
15502"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
15503will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
15504logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
15505
15506The format looks like this :
15507
15508 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
15509 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
15510 Connection error during SSL handshake
15511
15512 Field Format Extract from the example above
15513 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
15514 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
15515 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
15516 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
15517 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
15518
15519These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
15520failures.
15521
15522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155238.3. Advanced logging options
15524-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015525
15526Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
15527just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
15528options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
15529for more information about their usage.
15530
15531
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155328.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
15533------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015534
15535It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
15536haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
15537commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
15538monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
15539ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
15540
15541 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
15542 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
15543 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
15544 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
15545
15546 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
15547 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
15548 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015549 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015550 such as other load-balancers.
15551
15552 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
15553 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
15554 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
15555
15556
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155578.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
15558----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015559
15560The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
15561what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
15562or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
15563"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
15564just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
15565log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
15566after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
15567is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
15568with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
15569with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
15570
15571
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155728.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
15573------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015574
15575Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
15576for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
15577"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
15578retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
15579raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
15580a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
15581file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
15582you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
15583"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
15584
15585
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155868.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
15587--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015588
15589Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
15590multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
15591them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
15592"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
15593logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
15594error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
15595and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
15596too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
15597useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
15598alternative.
15599
15600
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156018.4. Timing events
15602------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015603
15604Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
15605reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
15606the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
15607frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015608mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
15609addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
15610
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010015611Timings events in HTTP mode:
15612
15613 first request 2nd request
15614 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
15615 t tr t tr ...
15616 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
15617 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
15618 :<---- Tq ---->: :
15619 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
15620 :<--------- Ta --------->:
15621
15622Timings events in TCP mode:
15623
15624 TCP session
15625 |<----------------->|
15626 t t
15627 ---|----|----|----|----|---
15628 | Th Tw Tc Td |
15629 |<------ Tt ------->|
15630
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015631 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
15632 protocols. Currently, these protocoles are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
15633 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
15634 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
15635 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
15636 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (eg: MTU issues), or that an
15637 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015638
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015639 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
15640 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
15641 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
15642 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. Some
15643 browsers pre-establish connections to a server in order to reduce the
15644 latency of a future request, and keep them pending until they need it. This
15645 delay will be reported as the idle time. A value of -1 indicates that
15646 nothing was received on the connection.
15647
15648 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
15649 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
15650 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
15651 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
15652 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
15653 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
15654 request typed by hand during a test.
15655
15656 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
15657 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
15658 exactly equalt to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
15659 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
15660 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
15661 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
15662 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015663
15664 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
15665 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
15666 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
15667 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
15668 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
15669
15670 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
15671 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
15672 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
15673 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
15674 connection never established.
15675
15676 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
15677 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
15678 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
15679 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
15680 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
15681 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
15682 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
15683 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
15684 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
15685 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
15686 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
15687
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015688 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
15689 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
15690 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
15691 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
15692 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
15693 by subtracting other timers when valid :
15694
15695 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
15696
15697 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
15698 "Ta" can never be negative.
15699
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015700 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
15701 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015702 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
15703 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015704 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015705
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015706 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015707
15708 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015709 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
15710 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015711
15712These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
15713protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
15714that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015715due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
15716"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
15717that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015718
15719Most common cases :
15720
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015721 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
15722 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
15723 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
15724 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
15725 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
15726 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
15727 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
15728 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
15729 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
15730 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
15731 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020015732 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015733
15734 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
15735 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
15736 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
15737 of ms on remote networks.
15738
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015739 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
15740 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
15741 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015742
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015743 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
15744 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
15745 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
15746 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
15747 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
15748 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
15749 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
15750 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
15751 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015752
15753Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
15754
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015755 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015756 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015757 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015758
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015759 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015760 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
15761 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
15762
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015763 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015764 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
15765 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
15766 flags.
15767
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015768 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
15769 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015770 Check the session termination flags, then check the
15771 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
15772 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
15773 the client connection was maintained open.
15774
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015775 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015776 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015777 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015778 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
15779
15780
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157818.5. Session state at disconnection
15782-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015783
15784TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
15785"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
157862-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
15787each of which has a special meaning :
15788
15789 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
15790 session to terminate :
15791
15792 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
15793
15794 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
15795 server explicitly refused it.
15796
15797 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
15798 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
15799 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
15800 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015801 (eg: cacheable cookie).
15802
15803 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
15804 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015805
15806 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
15807 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
15808 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
15809 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
15810 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
15811
15812 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
15813 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
15814 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
15815 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
15816 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
15817
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090015818 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
15819 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
15820
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015821 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
15822 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
15823 backup connections when going up.
15824
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020015825 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
15826
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015827 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
15828 send or receive data.
15829
15830 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
15831 send or receive data.
15832
15833 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
15834 with nothing left in the buffers.
15835
15836 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
15837
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010015838 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015839 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
15840
15841 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
15842 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
15843 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
15844 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
15845 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
15846
15847 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
15848 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
15849
15850 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
15851 server (HTTP only).
15852
15853 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
15854
15855 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
15856 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
15857 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
15858
15859 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
15860 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
15861 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
15862
15863 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
15864
15865 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
15866 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
15867
15868 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
15869 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
15870 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
15871
15872 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
15873 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020015874 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
15875 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015876
15877 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
15878 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
15879 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
15880 another server.
15881
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015882 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015883 server.
15884
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015885 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
15886 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
15887 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
15888 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15889
15890 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
15891 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
15892 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
15893 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15894
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020015895 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
15896 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
15897 "use-server" rule).
15898
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015899 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15900
15901 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
15902 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
15903
15904 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
15905
15906 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
15907 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
15908 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
15909
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015910 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
15911 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015912 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015913 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
15914 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
15915
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015916 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
15917
15918 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
15919 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
15920
15921 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
15922
15923 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15924
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015925The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
15926was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015927helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
15928starvation, attacks, etc...
15929
15930The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
15931alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
15932easier finding and understanding.
15933
15934 Flags Reason
15935
15936 -- Normal termination.
15937
15938 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
15939 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
15940 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
15941 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
15942
15943 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
15944 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
15945 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
15946 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
15947 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
15948 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015949
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015950 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
15951 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015952 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015953
15954 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
15955 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
15956 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
15957
15958 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
15959 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
15960 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
15961 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
15962 the server takes too long to respond.
15963
15964 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
15965 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
15966 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
15967 long a time to respond.
15968
15969 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
15970 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
15971 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
15972 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015973 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
15974 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015975
15976 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
15977 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
15978 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
15979 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
15980 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020015981 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015982 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
15983 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
15984 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
15985 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
15986 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
15987 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
15988 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
15989 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
15990 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
15991 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
15992 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
15993 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015994
15995 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
15996 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015997 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
15998 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
15999 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
16000 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016001
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016002 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
16003 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
16004
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016005 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016006 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
16007 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
16008 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
16009 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
16010 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
16011
16012 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
16013 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
16014 503 or 504 here.
16015
16016 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
16017 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
16018 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
16019 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
16020 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
16021
16022 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16023 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016024 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016025 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
16026 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
16027
16028 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
16029 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
16030 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
16031 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
16032 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
16033 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
16034 between haproxy and the server.
16035
16036 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
16037 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
16038 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
16039 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
16040 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
16041 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
16042 solution is to fix the application.
16043
16044 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
16045 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
16046 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
16047 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
16048 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
16049 external attacks.
16050
16051 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
16052 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016053 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016054 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
16055 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
16056
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016057 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
16058 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
16059 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020016060 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
16061 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016062
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016063 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
16064 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
16065 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
16066 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016067 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
16068 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
16069 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
16070 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
16071 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016072
16073 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
16074 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
16075 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
16076 returned an HTTP 403 error.
16077
16078 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
16079 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
16080 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
16081 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
16082
16083 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
16084 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
16085 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
16086 only be solved by proper system tuning.
16087
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016088The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
16089persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
16090important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
16091re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
16092
16093 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
16094
16095 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16096 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
16097 set on a GET request.
16098
16099 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
16100 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016101 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016102 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
16103
16104 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
16105 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
16106 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
16107
16108 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16109 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
16110 already got a cookie.
16111
16112 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16113 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
16114 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
16115 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
16116 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
16117
16118 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16119 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16120 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16121
16122 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
16123 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16124 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16125
16126 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
16127 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
16128
16129 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
16130 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
16131 then advertised in the response.
16132
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016133
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161348.6. Non-printable characters
16135-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016136
16137In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
16138consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
16139converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
16140prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
16141being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
16142escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
16143is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
16144'}' when logging headers.
16145
16146Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
16147issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
16148containing spaces is "User-Agent".
16149
16150Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
16151the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
16152performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
16153
16154
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161558.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
16156---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016157
16158Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
16159achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016160section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016161cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
16162the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
16163the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016164locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016165not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
16166user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
16167a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
16168wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
16169
16170 Examples :
16171 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
16172 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
16173
16174 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
16175 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
16176
16177
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161788.8. Capturing HTTP headers
16179---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016180
16181Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
16182proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
16183the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
16184server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
16185
16186Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
16187response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016188section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016189
16190It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016191time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
16192appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016193are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
16194and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
16195follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
16196request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
16197in the logs.
16198
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016199As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
16200frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
16201an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
16202
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016203 Example :
16204 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
16205 listen proxy-out
16206 mode http
16207 option httplog
16208 option logasap
16209 log global
16210 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
16211
16212 # log the name of the virtual server
16213 capture request header Host len 20
16214
16215 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
16216 capture request header Content-Length len 10
16217
16218 # log the beginning of the referrer
16219 capture request header Referer len 20
16220
16221 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
16222 capture response header Server len 20
16223
16224 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
16225 capture response header Content-Length len 10
16226
16227 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
16228 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
16229
16230 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
16231 capture response header Via len 20
16232
16233 # log the URL location during a redirection
16234 capture response header Location len 20
16235
16236 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
16237 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
16238 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16239 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
16240 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
16241
16242 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16243 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16244 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16245 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016246 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016247
16248 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16249 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16250 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16251 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
16252 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016253 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016254
16255
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162568.9. Examples of logs
16257---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016258
16259These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
16260them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
16261reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
16262
16263 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
16264 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16265 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16266
16267 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
16268 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
16269
16270 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
16271 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
16272 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16273
16274 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
16275 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
16276
16277 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
16278 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16279 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
16280
16281 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016282 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016283 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
16284 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
16285
16286 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
16287 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
16288 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
16289
16290 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
16291 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020016292 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016293 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
16294 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
16295 to return the 502 and not the server.
16296
16297 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016298 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016299
16300 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
16301 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
16302 Nothing was sent to any server.
16303
16304 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
16305 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
16306
16307 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
16308 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
16309 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
16310 send a 408 return code to the client.
16311
16312 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
16313 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
16314
16315 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
16316 5 seconds ("c----").
16317
16318 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
16319 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016320 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016321
16322 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016323 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016324 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
16325 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
16326 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
16327 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
16328 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016329
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020016330
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200163319. Supported filters
16332--------------------
16333
16334Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
16335accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
16336unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
16337
16338See also : "filter"
16339
163409.1. Trace
16341----------
16342
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016343filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016344
16345 Arguments:
16346 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
16347 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
16348
16349 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
16350 the client and the server. By default, this filter
16351 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
16352 only parses a random amount of the available data.
16353
16354 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
16355 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
16356 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
16357 amount of the parsed data.
16358
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016359 <hexump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
16360
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016361This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
16362callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
16363information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
16364filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
16365
16366Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
16367tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
16368a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
16369
16370
163719.2. HTTP compression
16372---------------------
16373
16374filter compression
16375
16376The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
16377keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
16378when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
16379use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
16380used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
16381filters evaluation order.
16382
16383See also : "compression"
16384
16385
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200163869.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
16387--------------------------------------------
16388
16389filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
16390
16391 Arguments :
16392
16393 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
16394 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
16395 parsed.
16396
16397 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
16398 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
16399 part must be placed in its own scope.
16400
16401The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
16402external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
16403streams in tierce applications. These external components and information
16404exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
16405also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
16406
16407SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
16408the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
16409
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016410For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020016411"doc/SPOE.txt".
16412
16413Important note:
16414 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
16415 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
16416
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016417/*
16418 * Local variables:
16419 * fill-column: 79
16420 * End:
16421 */